2002-05-17 David S. Miller <davem@redhat.com>
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blob2fa9f64817e9a2a4552acb9f0be59c409c26ab72
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from the GNU C compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
8 This file is part of GCC.
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
22 Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
23 02111-1307, USA. */
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
27 out locations for types and decls.
28 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35 information. */
37 #include "config.h"
38 #include "system.h"
39 #include "tree.h"
40 #include "flags.h"
41 #include "rtl.h"
42 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
43 #include "regs.h"
44 #include "insn-config.h"
45 #include "reload.h"
46 #include "function.h"
47 #include "output.h"
48 #include "expr.h"
49 #include "libfuncs.h"
50 #include "except.h"
51 #include "dwarf2.h"
52 #include "dwarf2out.h"
53 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
54 #include "toplev.h"
55 #include "varray.h"
56 #include "ggc.h"
57 #include "md5.h"
58 #include "tm_p.h"
59 #include "diagnostic.h"
60 #include "debug.h"
61 #include "target.h"
62 #include "langhooks.h"
63 #include "hashtable.h"
65 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
66 static void dwarf2out_source_line PARAMS ((unsigned int, const char *));
67 #endif
69 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
70 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
71 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
72 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
73 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
74 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
75 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
76 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
77 CIE = Common Information Entry
78 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
79 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
80 FDE = Frame Description Entry
81 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
82 how to restore registers
84 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
85 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
87 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
88 translation unit. */
90 int
91 dwarf2out_do_frame ()
93 return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
94 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
95 #ifdef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
96 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
97 #endif
98 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
99 || flag_unwind_tables
100 || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
101 #endif
105 /* The number of the current function definition for which debugging
106 information is being generated. These numbers range from 1 up to the
107 maximum number of function definitions contained within the current
108 compilation unit. These numbers are used to create unique label id's
109 unique to each function definition. */
110 unsigned current_funcdef_number = 0;
112 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
113 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
114 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
115 #endif
117 /* Default version of targetm.eh_frame_section. Note this must appear
118 outside the DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO || DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO macro
119 guards. */
121 void
122 default_eh_frame_section ()
124 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
125 named_section_flags (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, SECTION_WRITE);
126 #else
127 tree label = get_file_function_name ('F');
129 data_section ();
130 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
131 ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
132 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
133 #endif
136 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
138 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
139 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
140 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
141 #endif
143 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
144 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
145 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
147 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
148 Information instructions. The register number, offset
149 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
150 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
152 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct
154 unsigned long dw_cfi_reg_num;
155 long int dw_cfi_offset;
156 const char *dw_cfi_addr;
157 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_cfi_loc;
159 dw_cfi_oprnd;
161 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct
163 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
164 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
165 dw_cfi_oprnd dw_cfi_oprnd1;
166 dw_cfi_oprnd dw_cfi_oprnd2;
168 dw_cfi_node;
170 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
171 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
172 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
173 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
174 of this structure. */
175 typedef struct cfa_loc
177 unsigned long reg;
178 long offset;
179 long base_offset;
180 int indirect; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
181 } dw_cfa_location;
183 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
184 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
185 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
186 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
187 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
189 typedef struct dw_fde_struct
191 const char *dw_fde_begin;
192 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
193 const char *dw_fde_end;
194 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
195 unsigned funcdef_number;
196 unsigned nothrow : 1;
197 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
199 dw_fde_node;
201 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
202 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
204 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
205 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
206 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
207 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
208 pointers. */
209 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
210 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
211 #endif
213 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
214 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
215 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
216 as PTR_SIZE. */
218 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
219 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
220 #endif
222 #define DWARF_VERSION 2
224 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
225 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
226 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
228 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
229 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
230 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
231 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
232 #else
233 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
234 #endif
235 #endif
237 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
238 information for each routine. */
239 static dw_fde_ref fde_table;
241 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
242 static unsigned fde_table_allocated;
244 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
245 static unsigned fde_table_in_use;
247 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
248 fde_table. */
249 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
251 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
252 static dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
254 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
255 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
256 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
257 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
258 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
260 struct ht *debug_str_hash;
262 struct indirect_string_node
264 struct ht_identifier id;
265 unsigned int refcount;
266 unsigned int form;
267 char *label;
270 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
272 static char *stripattributes PARAMS ((const char *));
273 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
274 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi PARAMS ((void));
275 static void add_cfi PARAMS ((dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref));
276 static void add_fde_cfi PARAMS ((const char *, dw_cfi_ref));
277 static void lookup_cfa_1 PARAMS ((dw_cfi_ref,
278 dw_cfa_location *));
279 static void lookup_cfa PARAMS ((dw_cfa_location *));
280 static void reg_save PARAMS ((const char *, unsigned,
281 unsigned, long));
282 static void initial_return_save PARAMS ((rtx));
283 static long stack_adjust_offset PARAMS ((rtx));
284 static void output_cfi PARAMS ((dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int));
285 static void output_call_frame_info PARAMS ((int));
286 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust PARAMS ((rtx));
287 static void queue_reg_save PARAMS ((const char *, rtx, long));
288 static void flush_queued_reg_saves PARAMS ((void));
289 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save PARAMS ((rtx));
290 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr PARAMS ((rtx, const char *));
292 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
293 static void output_cfa_loc PARAMS ((dw_cfi_ref));
294 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr PARAMS ((dw_cfa_location *,
295 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *));
296 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
297 PARAMS ((dw_cfa_location *));
298 static void def_cfa_1 PARAMS ((const char *,
299 dw_cfa_location *));
301 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
302 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
303 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
304 #endif
306 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
307 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
308 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
310 /* Pseudo-op for defining a new section. */
311 #ifndef SECTION_ASM_OP
312 #define SECTION_ASM_OP "\t.section\t"
313 #endif
315 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
316 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
317 #endif
319 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
320 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
321 #endif
323 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
324 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
325 #endif
327 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
328 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
329 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
330 #define CIE_LENGTH_LABEL "LLCIE"
331 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
332 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
333 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
334 #define FDE_LENGTH_LABEL "LLFDE"
335 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
336 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
337 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
338 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
339 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
341 /* Definitions of defaults for various types of primitive assembly language
342 output operations. These may be overridden from within the tm.h file,
343 but typically, that is unnecessary. */
345 #ifdef SET_ASM_OP
346 #ifndef ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL
347 #define ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL(FILE, SY, HI, LO) \
348 do \
350 fprintf (FILE, "%s", SET_ASM_OP); \
351 assemble_name (FILE, SY); \
352 fputc (',', FILE); \
353 assemble_name (FILE, HI); \
354 fputc ('-', FILE); \
355 assemble_name (FILE, LO); \
357 while (0)
358 #endif
359 #endif
361 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
362 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
363 registers. */
364 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
365 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
366 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
367 #else
368 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
369 #endif
370 #endif
372 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
373 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
374 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
375 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
376 #endif
378 /* The offset from the incoming value of %sp to the top of the stack frame
379 for the current function. */
380 #ifndef INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
381 #define INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET 0
382 #endif
384 /* Hook used by __throw. */
387 expand_builtin_dwarf_fp_regnum ()
389 return GEN_INT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM));
392 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
393 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
395 static inline char *
396 stripattributes (s)
397 const char *s;
399 char *stripped = xmalloc (strlen (s) + 2);
400 char *p = stripped;
402 *p++ = '*';
404 while (*s && *s != ',')
405 *p++ = *s++;
407 *p = '\0';
408 return stripped;
411 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
413 void
414 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (address)
415 tree address;
417 int i;
418 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
419 rtx addr = expand_expr (address, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
420 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
422 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS; i++)
424 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
425 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (reg_raw_mode[i]);
427 if (offset < 0)
428 continue;
430 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
434 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
436 static const char *
437 dwarf_cfi_name (cfi_opc)
438 unsigned cfi_opc;
440 switch (cfi_opc)
442 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
443 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
444 case DW_CFA_offset:
445 return "DW_CFA_offset";
446 case DW_CFA_restore:
447 return "DW_CFA_restore";
448 case DW_CFA_nop:
449 return "DW_CFA_nop";
450 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
451 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
452 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
453 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
454 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
455 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
456 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
457 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
458 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
459 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
460 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
461 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
462 case DW_CFA_undefined:
463 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
464 case DW_CFA_same_value:
465 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
466 case DW_CFA_register:
467 return "DW_CFA_register";
468 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
469 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
470 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
471 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
472 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
473 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
474 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
475 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
476 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
477 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
479 /* DWARF 3 */
480 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
481 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
482 case DW_CFA_expression:
483 return "DW_CFA_expression";
484 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
485 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
486 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
487 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
488 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
489 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
491 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
492 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
493 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
495 /* GNU extensions */
496 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
497 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
498 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
499 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
500 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
501 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
503 default:
504 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
508 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
510 static inline dw_cfi_ref
511 new_cfi ()
513 dw_cfi_ref cfi = (dw_cfi_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
515 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
516 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
517 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
519 return cfi;
522 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
524 static inline void
525 add_cfi (list_head, cfi)
526 dw_cfi_ref *list_head;
527 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
529 dw_cfi_ref *p;
531 /* Find the end of the chain. */
532 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
535 *p = cfi;
538 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. */
540 char *
541 dwarf2out_cfi_label ()
543 static char label[20];
544 static unsigned long label_num = 0;
546 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", label_num++);
547 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
548 return label;
551 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
552 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
554 static void
555 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi)
556 const char *label;
557 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
559 if (label)
561 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
563 if (*label == 0)
564 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
566 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
567 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
569 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
571 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label = xstrdup (label);
573 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
574 xcfi = new_cfi ();
575 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
576 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
577 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
580 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
583 else
584 add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
587 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
589 static inline void
590 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc)
591 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
592 dw_cfa_location *loc;
594 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
596 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
597 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
598 break;
599 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
600 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
601 break;
602 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
603 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
604 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
605 break;
606 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
607 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
608 break;
609 default:
610 break;
614 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
616 static void
617 lookup_cfa (loc)
618 dw_cfa_location *loc;
620 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
622 loc->reg = (unsigned long) -1;
623 loc->offset = 0;
624 loc->indirect = 0;
625 loc->base_offset = 0;
627 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
628 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
630 if (fde_table_in_use)
632 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
633 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
634 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
638 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
639 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
641 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
642 from the CFA. */
643 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
645 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
646 static long args_size;
648 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
649 static long old_args_size;
651 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
652 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
653 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
655 void
656 dwarf2out_def_cfa (label, reg, offset)
657 const char *label;
658 unsigned reg;
659 long offset;
661 dw_cfa_location loc;
662 loc.indirect = 0;
663 loc.base_offset = 0;
664 loc.reg = reg;
665 loc.offset = offset;
666 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
669 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
670 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
672 static void
673 def_cfa_1 (label, loc_p)
674 const char *label;
675 dw_cfa_location *loc_p;
677 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
678 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
680 cfa = *loc_p;
681 loc = *loc_p;
683 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
684 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
686 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
687 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
689 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
690 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
691 && loc.indirect == old_cfa.indirect
692 && (loc.indirect == 0 || loc.base_offset == old_cfa.base_offset))
693 return;
695 cfi = new_cfi ();
697 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
699 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction,
700 indicating the CFA register did not change but the offset
701 did. */
702 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
703 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
706 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
707 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset && old_cfa.reg != (unsigned long) -1
708 && !loc.indirect)
710 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
711 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
712 offset has not changed. */
713 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
714 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
716 #endif
718 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
720 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
721 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
722 the specified offset. */
723 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
724 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
725 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
727 else
729 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
730 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
731 register-offset pair is available. */
732 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
734 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
735 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc);
736 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
739 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
742 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
743 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
744 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
745 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
747 static void
748 reg_save (label, reg, sreg, offset)
749 const char *label;
750 unsigned reg;
751 unsigned sreg;
752 long offset;
754 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
756 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
758 /* The following comparison is correct. -1 is used to indicate that
759 the value isn't a register number. */
760 if (sreg == (unsigned int) -1)
762 if (reg & ~0x3f)
763 /* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
764 the long form. */
765 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
766 else
767 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
769 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
771 /* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
772 DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
773 definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
774 description. */
775 long check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
777 if (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT != offset)
778 abort ();
780 #endif
781 offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
782 if (offset < 0)
783 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
785 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
787 else if (sreg == reg)
788 /* We could emit a DW_CFA_same_value in this case, but don't bother. */
789 return;
790 else
792 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
793 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
796 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
799 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
800 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
801 from the previous frame's window save area.
803 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
804 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
806 void
807 dwarf2out_window_save (label)
808 const char *label;
810 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
812 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
813 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
816 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
817 pushed onto the stack. */
819 void
820 dwarf2out_args_size (label, size)
821 const char *label;
822 long size;
824 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
826 if (size == old_args_size)
827 return;
829 old_args_size = size;
831 cfi = new_cfi ();
832 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
833 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
834 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
837 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
838 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
840 void
841 dwarf2out_reg_save (label, reg, offset)
842 const char *label;
843 unsigned reg;
844 long offset;
846 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), -1, offset);
849 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
850 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
852 void
853 dwarf2out_return_save (label, offset)
854 const char *label;
855 long offset;
857 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, -1, offset);
860 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
861 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
863 void
864 dwarf2out_return_reg (label, sreg)
865 const char *label;
866 unsigned sreg;
868 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, sreg, 0);
871 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
872 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
874 static void
875 initial_return_save (rtl)
876 rtx rtl;
878 unsigned int reg = (unsigned int) -1;
879 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
881 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
883 case REG:
884 /* RA is in a register. */
885 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
886 break;
888 case MEM:
889 /* RA is on the stack. */
890 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
891 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
893 case REG:
894 if (REGNO (rtl) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
895 abort ();
896 offset = 0;
897 break;
899 case PLUS:
900 if (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
901 abort ();
902 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
903 break;
905 case MINUS:
906 if (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
907 abort ();
908 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
909 break;
911 default:
912 abort ();
915 break;
917 case PLUS:
918 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
919 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
920 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
921 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != CONST_INT)
922 abort ();
923 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
924 return;
926 default:
927 abort ();
930 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
933 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
934 contains. */
936 static long
937 stack_adjust_offset (pattern)
938 rtx pattern;
940 rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
941 rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
942 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
943 enum rtx_code code;
945 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
947 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
948 code = GET_CODE (src);
949 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
950 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
951 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
952 return 0;
954 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
955 if (code == PLUS)
956 offset = -offset;
958 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
960 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
961 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
962 code = GET_CODE (src);
964 switch (code)
966 case PRE_MODIFY:
967 case POST_MODIFY:
968 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
970 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
971 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
972 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != PLUS ||
973 GET_CODE (val) != CONST_INT)
974 abort ();
975 offset = -INTVAL (val);
976 break;
978 return 0;
980 case PRE_DEC:
981 case POST_DEC:
982 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
984 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
985 break;
987 return 0;
989 case PRE_INC:
990 case POST_INC:
991 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
993 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
994 break;
996 return 0;
998 default:
999 return 0;
1002 else
1003 return 0;
1005 return offset;
1008 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1009 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
1010 much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1012 static void
1013 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn)
1014 rtx insn;
1016 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1017 const char *label;
1018 int i;
1020 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
1022 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1023 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1024 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1025 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1026 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1027 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1028 if (GET_CODE (insn) != CALL)
1029 abort ();
1031 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1032 return;
1035 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1036 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1037 else if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1038 return;
1040 if (GET_CODE (insn) == BARRIER)
1042 /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0. Usually
1043 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1044 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions. */
1045 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1046 offset = -args_size;
1047 #else
1048 offset = args_size;
1049 #endif
1051 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1052 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
1053 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1054 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1056 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1057 for them. */
1058 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1059 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1060 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
1062 else
1063 return;
1065 if (offset == 0)
1066 return;
1068 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1069 cfa.offset += offset;
1071 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1072 offset = -offset;
1073 #endif
1075 args_size += offset;
1076 if (args_size < 0)
1077 args_size = 0;
1079 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1080 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1081 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1084 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1085 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1086 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1088 struct queued_reg_save
1090 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1091 rtx reg;
1092 long cfa_offset;
1095 static struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1096 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1098 static void
1099 queue_reg_save (label, reg, offset)
1100 const char *label;
1101 rtx reg;
1102 long offset;
1104 struct queued_reg_save *q = (struct queued_reg_save *) xmalloc (sizeof (*q));
1106 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1107 q->reg = reg;
1108 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1109 queued_reg_saves = q;
1111 last_reg_save_label = label;
1114 static void
1115 flush_queued_reg_saves ()
1117 struct queued_reg_save *q, *next;
1119 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = next)
1121 dwarf2out_reg_save (last_reg_save_label, REGNO (q->reg), q->cfa_offset);
1122 next = q->next;
1123 free (q);
1126 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1127 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1130 static bool
1131 clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn)
1132 rtx insn;
1134 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1136 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1137 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1138 return true;
1140 return false;
1144 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1145 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1146 value, not an offset. */
1147 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1149 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1150 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1151 address) or saves a register to the stack. LABEL indicates the
1152 address of EXPR.
1154 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1155 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1156 users need not read the source code.
1158 The High-Level Picture
1160 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1161 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1162 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1163 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1164 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1166 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1167 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
1168 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1169 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1170 saves. This also seems to work.
1172 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1173 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1174 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1175 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1177 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1178 offset is non-zero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1179 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
1180 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1182 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1184 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
1185 consists of a register and an offset.
1186 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1187 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1188 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1189 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
1190 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1191 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1192 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1194 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1195 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1196 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1197 cfa_temp.offset.
1199 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1200 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
1201 and cfa_temp.offset.
1203 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1204 stack.
1206 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
1207 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1208 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1210 The Rules
1212 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1213 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1215 Rule 1:
1216 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1217 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1218 cfa.offset unchanged
1219 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1220 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1222 Rule 2:
1223 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1224 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1225 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1226 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1227 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1228 if cfa_store.reg==sp
1230 Rule 3:
1231 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1232 effects: cfa.reg = fp
1233 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1235 Rule 4:
1236 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1237 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1238 <reg1> != sp
1239 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1240 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1241 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1243 Rule 5:
1244 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1245 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1246 <reg1> != sp
1247 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1248 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1250 Rule 6:
1251 (set <reg> <const_int>)
1252 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1253 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1255 Rule 7:
1256 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1257 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1258 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1260 Rule 8:
1261 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1262 effects: none
1264 Rule 9:
1265 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1266 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1267 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1269 Rule 10:
1270 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1271 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1272 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1273 cfa.reg = sp
1274 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1276 Rule 11:
1277 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1278 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1279 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1280 cfa.reg = sp
1281 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1283 Rule 12:
1284 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1286 <reg2>)
1287 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1288 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1290 Rule 13:
1291 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1292 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1293 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1295 Rule 14:
1296 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1297 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1298 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1299 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem) */
1301 static void
1302 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (expr, label)
1303 rtx expr;
1304 const char *label;
1306 rtx src, dest;
1307 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1309 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1310 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1311 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
1312 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1313 flag is set in them. */
1314 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1316 int par_index;
1317 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
1319 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1320 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index)) == SET
1321 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index))
1322 || par_index == 0))
1323 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index), label);
1325 return;
1328 if (GET_CODE (expr) != SET)
1329 abort ();
1331 src = SET_SRC (expr);
1332 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
1334 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
1336 case REG:
1337 /* Rule 1 */
1338 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
1339 relative to the current CFA register. */
1340 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1342 /* Setting FP from SP. */
1343 case REG:
1344 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
1345 /* OK. */
1347 else
1348 abort ();
1350 /* We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1351 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1352 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
1353 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
1354 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1355 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1356 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1357 break;
1359 case PLUS:
1360 case MINUS:
1361 case LO_SUM:
1362 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1364 /* Rule 2 */
1365 /* Adjusting SP. */
1366 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
1368 case CONST_INT:
1369 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1370 break;
1371 case REG:
1372 if ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1)) != cfa_temp.reg)
1373 abort ();
1374 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
1375 break;
1376 default:
1377 abort ();
1380 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1382 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
1383 if (cfa.reg != (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
1384 abort ();
1385 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1387 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
1388 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
1390 else if (XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx)
1391 abort ();
1393 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1394 offset = -offset;
1395 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1396 cfa.offset += offset;
1397 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1398 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1400 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1402 /* Rule 3 */
1403 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1404 or adjusting the FP */
1405 if (! frame_pointer_needed)
1406 abort ();
1408 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == REG
1409 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1410 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1412 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1413 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1414 offset = -offset;
1415 cfa.offset += offset;
1416 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1418 else
1419 abort ();
1421 else
1423 if (GET_CODE (src) == MINUS)
1424 abort ();
1426 /* Rule 4 */
1427 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == REG
1428 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1429 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1431 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1432 into the FP later on. */
1433 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1434 cfa.offset += offset;
1435 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1436 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
1437 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1438 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1441 /* Rule 5 */
1442 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == REG
1443 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1444 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1446 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1447 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
1448 if (cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1449 abort ();
1450 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
1451 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
1454 /* Rule 9 */
1455 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
1456 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1458 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1459 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1461 else
1462 abort ();
1464 break;
1466 /* Rule 6 */
1467 case CONST_INT:
1468 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1469 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
1470 break;
1472 /* Rule 7 */
1473 case IOR:
1474 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) != REG
1475 || (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) != cfa_temp.reg
1476 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
1477 abort ();
1479 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
1480 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1481 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1482 break;
1484 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1485 which will fill in all of the bits. */
1486 /* Rule 8 */
1487 case HIGH:
1488 break;
1490 default:
1491 abort ();
1494 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1495 break;
1497 case MEM:
1498 if (GET_CODE (src) != REG)
1499 abort ();
1501 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
1502 CFA register. */
1503 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1505 /* Rule 10 */
1506 /* With a push. */
1507 case PRE_MODIFY:
1508 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
1509 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1)) != CONST_INT)
1510 abort ();
1511 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
1513 if (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1514 || cfa_store.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1515 abort ();
1517 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1518 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1519 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1521 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1522 break;
1524 /* Rule 11 */
1525 case PRE_INC:
1526 case PRE_DEC:
1527 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1528 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
1529 offset = -offset;
1531 if (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1532 || cfa_store.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1533 abort ();
1535 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1536 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1537 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1539 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1540 break;
1542 /* Rule 12 */
1543 /* With an offset. */
1544 case PLUS:
1545 case MINUS:
1546 case LO_SUM:
1547 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) != CONST_INT)
1548 abort ();
1549 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
1550 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
1551 offset = -offset;
1553 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)))
1554 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
1555 else if (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)))
1556 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
1557 else
1558 abort ();
1559 break;
1561 /* Rule 13 */
1562 /* Without an offset. */
1563 case REG:
1564 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1565 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1566 else if (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1567 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1568 else
1569 abort ();
1570 break;
1572 /* Rule 14 */
1573 case POST_INC:
1574 if (cfa_temp.reg != (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)))
1575 abort ();
1576 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1577 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1578 break;
1580 default:
1581 abort ();
1584 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1585 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1586 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
1588 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
1590 if (cfa.offset == 0)
1592 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1593 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1594 on the ARM. */
1595 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1596 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, offset);
1597 break;
1599 else
1601 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1602 calculate the CFA. */
1603 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
1605 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
1606 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1607 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
1608 abort ();
1610 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
1611 cfa.base_offset = offset;
1612 cfa.indirect = 1;
1613 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1614 break;
1618 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1619 queue_reg_save (label, src, offset);
1620 break;
1622 default:
1623 abort ();
1627 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1628 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1629 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state. */
1631 void
1632 dwarf2out_frame_debug (insn)
1633 rtx insn;
1635 const char *label;
1636 rtx src;
1638 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
1640 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
1641 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1643 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
1644 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
1645 if (cfa.reg != (unsigned long) DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM))
1646 abort ();
1648 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1649 cfa_store = cfa;
1650 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
1651 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
1652 return;
1655 if (GET_CODE (insn) != INSN || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
1656 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1658 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1660 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1661 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn);
1663 return;
1666 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1667 src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1668 if (src)
1669 insn = XEXP (src, 0);
1670 else
1671 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1673 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
1676 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
1678 static void
1679 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh)
1680 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1681 dw_fde_ref fde;
1682 int for_eh;
1684 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
1685 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
1686 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
1687 "DW_CFA_advance_loc 0x%lx",
1688 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
1689 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
1691 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
1692 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num & 0x3f)),
1693 "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx",
1694 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num);
1695 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1697 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
1698 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
1699 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num & 0x3f)),
1700 "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx",
1701 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num);
1702 else
1704 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
1705 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
1707 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
1709 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1710 if (for_eh)
1711 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
1712 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
1713 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
1714 NULL);
1715 else
1716 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
1717 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
1718 break;
1720 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1721 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1722 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1723 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1724 break;
1726 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1727 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1728 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1729 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1730 break;
1732 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1733 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1734 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1735 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1736 break;
1738 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1739 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1740 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1741 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1742 break;
1744 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1745 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1746 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1747 NULL);
1748 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1749 break;
1751 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1752 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1753 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1754 NULL);
1755 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1756 break;
1758 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
1759 case DW_CFA_undefined:
1760 case DW_CFA_same_value:
1761 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1762 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1763 NULL);
1764 break;
1766 case DW_CFA_register:
1767 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1768 NULL);
1769 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1770 NULL);
1771 break;
1773 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1774 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
1775 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1776 break;
1778 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1779 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1780 break;
1782 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1783 break;
1785 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1786 case DW_CFA_expression:
1787 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
1788 break;
1790 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
1791 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
1792 abort ();
1794 default:
1795 break;
1800 /* Output the call frame information used to used to record information
1801 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
1802 location of saved registers. */
1804 static void
1805 output_call_frame_info (for_eh)
1806 int for_eh;
1808 unsigned int i;
1809 dw_fde_ref fde;
1810 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1811 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
1812 int any_lsda_needed = 0;
1813 char augmentation[6];
1814 int augmentation_size;
1815 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
1816 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
1817 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
1819 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
1820 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
1821 return;
1823 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit any
1824 EH unwind information. */
1825 if (for_eh)
1827 int any_eh_needed = flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
1829 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
1830 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
1831 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = 1;
1832 else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow)
1833 any_eh_needed = 1;
1835 if (! any_eh_needed)
1836 return;
1839 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
1840 if (flag_debug_asm)
1841 app_enable ();
1843 if (for_eh)
1844 (*targetm.asm_out.eh_frame_section) ();
1845 else
1846 named_section_flags (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
1848 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
1849 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
1851 /* Output the CIE. */
1852 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
1853 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
1854 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
1855 "Length of Common Information Entry");
1856 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
1858 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
1859 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
1860 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
1861 (for_eh ? 0 : DW_CIE_ID),
1862 "CIE Identifier Tag");
1864 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
1866 augmentation[0] = 0;
1867 augmentation_size = 0;
1868 if (for_eh)
1870 char *p;
1872 /* Augmentation:
1873 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
1874 augmentation section.
1875 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
1876 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
1877 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
1878 FDE code pointers.
1879 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
1880 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
1882 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
1883 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
1884 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
1886 p = augmentation + 1;
1887 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
1889 *p++ = 'P';
1890 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
1892 if (any_lsda_needed)
1894 *p++ = 'L';
1895 augmentation_size += 1;
1897 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
1899 *p++ = 'R';
1900 augmentation_size += 1;
1902 if (p > augmentation + 1)
1904 augmentation[0] = 'z';
1905 *p = '\0';
1908 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
1909 if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
1911 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
1912 + 4 /* CIE Id */
1913 + 1 /* CIE version */
1914 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
1915 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
1916 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
1917 + 1 /* RA column */
1918 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
1919 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
1920 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
1922 augmentation_size += pad;
1924 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
1925 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
1926 if (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) != 1)
1927 abort ();
1931 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
1932 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
1933 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
1934 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
1935 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, "CIE RA Column");
1937 if (augmentation[0])
1939 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
1940 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
1942 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
1943 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
1944 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
1945 eh_personality_libfunc, NULL);
1948 if (any_lsda_needed)
1949 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
1950 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
1952 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
1953 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
1954 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
1957 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
1958 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
1960 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
1961 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
1962 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
1963 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
1965 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
1966 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
1968 fde = &fde_table[i];
1970 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
1971 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && for_eh && fde->nothrow
1972 && ! fde->uses_eh_lsda)
1973 continue;
1975 ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
1976 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
1977 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
1978 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
1979 "FDE Length");
1980 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
1982 if (for_eh)
1983 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
1984 else
1985 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
1986 "FDE CIE offset");
1988 if (for_eh)
1990 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
1991 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin),
1992 "FDE initial location");
1993 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
1994 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
1995 "FDE address range");
1997 else
1999 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2000 "FDE initial location");
2001 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2002 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2003 "FDE address range");
2006 if (augmentation[0])
2008 if (any_lsda_needed)
2010 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
2012 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2014 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2015 + 4 /* CIE offset */
2016 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
2017 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
2018 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2020 size += pad;
2021 if (size_of_uleb128 (size) != 1)
2022 abort ();
2025 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
2027 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2029 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
2030 fde->funcdef_number);
2031 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2032 lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
2033 "Language Specific Data Area");
2035 else
2037 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2038 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2039 dw2_asm_output_data
2040 (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
2041 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2044 else
2045 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2048 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2049 this FDE. */
2050 fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
2051 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2052 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
2054 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
2055 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2056 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
2057 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2060 #ifndef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
2061 if (for_eh)
2062 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2063 #endif
2064 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2065 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2066 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
2067 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
2068 #endif
2070 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
2071 if (flag_debug_asm)
2072 app_disable ();
2075 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2076 the prologue. */
2078 void
2079 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (line, file)
2080 unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
2081 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
2083 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2084 dw_fde_ref fde;
2086 current_function_func_begin_label = 0;
2088 #ifdef IA64_UNWIND_INFO
2089 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2090 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
2091 be used. */
2092 if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
2093 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2094 return;
2095 #else
2096 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2097 return;
2098 #endif
2100 current_funcdef_number++;
2101 function_section (current_function_decl);
2102 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2103 current_funcdef_number);
2104 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2105 current_funcdef_number);
2106 current_function_func_begin_label = get_identifier (label);
2108 #ifdef IA64_UNWIND_INFO
2109 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
2110 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2111 return;
2112 #endif
2114 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
2115 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
2117 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2118 fde_table
2119 = (dw_fde_ref) xrealloc (fde_table,
2120 fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2123 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
2124 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
2126 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
2127 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
2128 fde->dw_fde_begin = xstrdup (label);
2129 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
2130 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
2131 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
2132 fde->funcdef_number = current_funcdef_number;
2133 fde->nothrow = current_function_nothrow;
2134 fde->uses_eh_lsda = cfun->uses_eh_lsda;
2136 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
2138 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2139 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
2140 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2141 if (file)
2142 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
2143 #endif
2146 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2147 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2148 been generated. */
2150 void
2151 dwarf2out_end_epilogue ()
2153 dw_fde_ref fde;
2154 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2156 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2157 function. */
2158 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL, current_funcdef_number);
2159 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
2160 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2161 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
2164 void
2165 dwarf2out_frame_init ()
2167 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
2168 fde_table = (dw_fde_ref) xcalloc (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT, sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2169 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2170 fde_table_in_use = 0;
2172 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
2173 sake of lookup_cfa. */
2175 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2176 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
2177 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
2178 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
2179 #endif
2182 void
2183 dwarf2out_frame_finish ()
2185 /* Output call frame information. */
2186 if (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
2187 output_call_frame_info (0);
2189 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
2190 output_call_frame_info (1);
2193 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2194 for emitting location expressions. */
2196 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
2197 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
2198 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
2199 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
2201 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
2202 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
2203 implementation are listed below. */
2205 typedef enum
2207 dw_val_class_addr,
2208 dw_val_class_offset,
2209 dw_val_class_loc,
2210 dw_val_class_loc_list,
2211 dw_val_class_range_list,
2212 dw_val_class_const,
2213 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
2214 dw_val_class_long_long,
2215 dw_val_class_float,
2216 dw_val_class_flag,
2217 dw_val_class_die_ref,
2218 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
2219 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
2220 dw_val_class_lbl_offset,
2221 dw_val_class_str
2223 dw_val_class;
2225 /* Describe a double word constant value. */
2226 /* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE. */
2228 typedef struct dw_long_long_struct
2230 unsigned long hi;
2231 unsigned long low;
2233 dw_long_long_const;
2235 /* Describe a floating point constant value. */
2237 typedef struct dw_fp_struct
2239 long *array;
2240 unsigned length;
2242 dw_float_const;
2244 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2245 represented internally. */
2247 typedef struct dw_val_struct
2249 dw_val_class val_class;
2250 union
2252 rtx val_addr;
2253 long unsigned val_offset;
2254 dw_loc_list_ref val_loc_list;
2255 dw_loc_descr_ref val_loc;
2256 long int val_int;
2257 long unsigned val_unsigned;
2258 dw_long_long_const val_long_long;
2259 dw_float_const val_float;
2260 struct
2262 dw_die_ref die;
2263 int external;
2264 } val_die_ref;
2265 unsigned val_fde_index;
2266 struct indirect_string_node *val_str;
2267 char *val_lbl_id;
2268 unsigned char val_flag;
2272 dw_val_node;
2274 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2275 operations. */
2277 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct
2279 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
2280 enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
2281 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
2282 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
2283 int dw_loc_addr;
2285 dw_loc_descr_node;
2287 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2288 so you can track variables that are in different places over
2289 their entire life. */
2290 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct
2292 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
2293 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
2294 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
2295 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2296 Only on head of list */
2297 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2298 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
2299 } dw_loc_list_node;
2301 static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
2302 static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr PARAMS ((enum dwarf_location_atom,
2303 unsigned long,
2304 unsigned long));
2305 static void add_loc_descr PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref *,
2306 dw_loc_descr_ref));
2307 static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref));
2308 static unsigned long size_of_locs PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref));
2309 static void output_loc_operands PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref));
2310 static void output_loc_sequence PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref));
2312 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
2314 static const char *
2315 dwarf_stack_op_name (op)
2316 unsigned op;
2318 switch (op)
2320 case DW_OP_addr:
2321 return "DW_OP_addr";
2322 case DW_OP_deref:
2323 return "DW_OP_deref";
2324 case DW_OP_const1u:
2325 return "DW_OP_const1u";
2326 case DW_OP_const1s:
2327 return "DW_OP_const1s";
2328 case DW_OP_const2u:
2329 return "DW_OP_const2u";
2330 case DW_OP_const2s:
2331 return "DW_OP_const2s";
2332 case DW_OP_const4u:
2333 return "DW_OP_const4u";
2334 case DW_OP_const4s:
2335 return "DW_OP_const4s";
2336 case DW_OP_const8u:
2337 return "DW_OP_const8u";
2338 case DW_OP_const8s:
2339 return "DW_OP_const8s";
2340 case DW_OP_constu:
2341 return "DW_OP_constu";
2342 case DW_OP_consts:
2343 return "DW_OP_consts";
2344 case DW_OP_dup:
2345 return "DW_OP_dup";
2346 case DW_OP_drop:
2347 return "DW_OP_drop";
2348 case DW_OP_over:
2349 return "DW_OP_over";
2350 case DW_OP_pick:
2351 return "DW_OP_pick";
2352 case DW_OP_swap:
2353 return "DW_OP_swap";
2354 case DW_OP_rot:
2355 return "DW_OP_rot";
2356 case DW_OP_xderef:
2357 return "DW_OP_xderef";
2358 case DW_OP_abs:
2359 return "DW_OP_abs";
2360 case DW_OP_and:
2361 return "DW_OP_and";
2362 case DW_OP_div:
2363 return "DW_OP_div";
2364 case DW_OP_minus:
2365 return "DW_OP_minus";
2366 case DW_OP_mod:
2367 return "DW_OP_mod";
2368 case DW_OP_mul:
2369 return "DW_OP_mul";
2370 case DW_OP_neg:
2371 return "DW_OP_neg";
2372 case DW_OP_not:
2373 return "DW_OP_not";
2374 case DW_OP_or:
2375 return "DW_OP_or";
2376 case DW_OP_plus:
2377 return "DW_OP_plus";
2378 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2379 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2380 case DW_OP_shl:
2381 return "DW_OP_shl";
2382 case DW_OP_shr:
2383 return "DW_OP_shr";
2384 case DW_OP_shra:
2385 return "DW_OP_shra";
2386 case DW_OP_xor:
2387 return "DW_OP_xor";
2388 case DW_OP_bra:
2389 return "DW_OP_bra";
2390 case DW_OP_eq:
2391 return "DW_OP_eq";
2392 case DW_OP_ge:
2393 return "DW_OP_ge";
2394 case DW_OP_gt:
2395 return "DW_OP_gt";
2396 case DW_OP_le:
2397 return "DW_OP_le";
2398 case DW_OP_lt:
2399 return "DW_OP_lt";
2400 case DW_OP_ne:
2401 return "DW_OP_ne";
2402 case DW_OP_skip:
2403 return "DW_OP_skip";
2404 case DW_OP_lit0:
2405 return "DW_OP_lit0";
2406 case DW_OP_lit1:
2407 return "DW_OP_lit1";
2408 case DW_OP_lit2:
2409 return "DW_OP_lit2";
2410 case DW_OP_lit3:
2411 return "DW_OP_lit3";
2412 case DW_OP_lit4:
2413 return "DW_OP_lit4";
2414 case DW_OP_lit5:
2415 return "DW_OP_lit5";
2416 case DW_OP_lit6:
2417 return "DW_OP_lit6";
2418 case DW_OP_lit7:
2419 return "DW_OP_lit7";
2420 case DW_OP_lit8:
2421 return "DW_OP_lit8";
2422 case DW_OP_lit9:
2423 return "DW_OP_lit9";
2424 case DW_OP_lit10:
2425 return "DW_OP_lit10";
2426 case DW_OP_lit11:
2427 return "DW_OP_lit11";
2428 case DW_OP_lit12:
2429 return "DW_OP_lit12";
2430 case DW_OP_lit13:
2431 return "DW_OP_lit13";
2432 case DW_OP_lit14:
2433 return "DW_OP_lit14";
2434 case DW_OP_lit15:
2435 return "DW_OP_lit15";
2436 case DW_OP_lit16:
2437 return "DW_OP_lit16";
2438 case DW_OP_lit17:
2439 return "DW_OP_lit17";
2440 case DW_OP_lit18:
2441 return "DW_OP_lit18";
2442 case DW_OP_lit19:
2443 return "DW_OP_lit19";
2444 case DW_OP_lit20:
2445 return "DW_OP_lit20";
2446 case DW_OP_lit21:
2447 return "DW_OP_lit21";
2448 case DW_OP_lit22:
2449 return "DW_OP_lit22";
2450 case DW_OP_lit23:
2451 return "DW_OP_lit23";
2452 case DW_OP_lit24:
2453 return "DW_OP_lit24";
2454 case DW_OP_lit25:
2455 return "DW_OP_lit25";
2456 case DW_OP_lit26:
2457 return "DW_OP_lit26";
2458 case DW_OP_lit27:
2459 return "DW_OP_lit27";
2460 case DW_OP_lit28:
2461 return "DW_OP_lit28";
2462 case DW_OP_lit29:
2463 return "DW_OP_lit29";
2464 case DW_OP_lit30:
2465 return "DW_OP_lit30";
2466 case DW_OP_lit31:
2467 return "DW_OP_lit31";
2468 case DW_OP_reg0:
2469 return "DW_OP_reg0";
2470 case DW_OP_reg1:
2471 return "DW_OP_reg1";
2472 case DW_OP_reg2:
2473 return "DW_OP_reg2";
2474 case DW_OP_reg3:
2475 return "DW_OP_reg3";
2476 case DW_OP_reg4:
2477 return "DW_OP_reg4";
2478 case DW_OP_reg5:
2479 return "DW_OP_reg5";
2480 case DW_OP_reg6:
2481 return "DW_OP_reg6";
2482 case DW_OP_reg7:
2483 return "DW_OP_reg7";
2484 case DW_OP_reg8:
2485 return "DW_OP_reg8";
2486 case DW_OP_reg9:
2487 return "DW_OP_reg9";
2488 case DW_OP_reg10:
2489 return "DW_OP_reg10";
2490 case DW_OP_reg11:
2491 return "DW_OP_reg11";
2492 case DW_OP_reg12:
2493 return "DW_OP_reg12";
2494 case DW_OP_reg13:
2495 return "DW_OP_reg13";
2496 case DW_OP_reg14:
2497 return "DW_OP_reg14";
2498 case DW_OP_reg15:
2499 return "DW_OP_reg15";
2500 case DW_OP_reg16:
2501 return "DW_OP_reg16";
2502 case DW_OP_reg17:
2503 return "DW_OP_reg17";
2504 case DW_OP_reg18:
2505 return "DW_OP_reg18";
2506 case DW_OP_reg19:
2507 return "DW_OP_reg19";
2508 case DW_OP_reg20:
2509 return "DW_OP_reg20";
2510 case DW_OP_reg21:
2511 return "DW_OP_reg21";
2512 case DW_OP_reg22:
2513 return "DW_OP_reg22";
2514 case DW_OP_reg23:
2515 return "DW_OP_reg23";
2516 case DW_OP_reg24:
2517 return "DW_OP_reg24";
2518 case DW_OP_reg25:
2519 return "DW_OP_reg25";
2520 case DW_OP_reg26:
2521 return "DW_OP_reg26";
2522 case DW_OP_reg27:
2523 return "DW_OP_reg27";
2524 case DW_OP_reg28:
2525 return "DW_OP_reg28";
2526 case DW_OP_reg29:
2527 return "DW_OP_reg29";
2528 case DW_OP_reg30:
2529 return "DW_OP_reg30";
2530 case DW_OP_reg31:
2531 return "DW_OP_reg31";
2532 case DW_OP_breg0:
2533 return "DW_OP_breg0";
2534 case DW_OP_breg1:
2535 return "DW_OP_breg1";
2536 case DW_OP_breg2:
2537 return "DW_OP_breg2";
2538 case DW_OP_breg3:
2539 return "DW_OP_breg3";
2540 case DW_OP_breg4:
2541 return "DW_OP_breg4";
2542 case DW_OP_breg5:
2543 return "DW_OP_breg5";
2544 case DW_OP_breg6:
2545 return "DW_OP_breg6";
2546 case DW_OP_breg7:
2547 return "DW_OP_breg7";
2548 case DW_OP_breg8:
2549 return "DW_OP_breg8";
2550 case DW_OP_breg9:
2551 return "DW_OP_breg9";
2552 case DW_OP_breg10:
2553 return "DW_OP_breg10";
2554 case DW_OP_breg11:
2555 return "DW_OP_breg11";
2556 case DW_OP_breg12:
2557 return "DW_OP_breg12";
2558 case DW_OP_breg13:
2559 return "DW_OP_breg13";
2560 case DW_OP_breg14:
2561 return "DW_OP_breg14";
2562 case DW_OP_breg15:
2563 return "DW_OP_breg15";
2564 case DW_OP_breg16:
2565 return "DW_OP_breg16";
2566 case DW_OP_breg17:
2567 return "DW_OP_breg17";
2568 case DW_OP_breg18:
2569 return "DW_OP_breg18";
2570 case DW_OP_breg19:
2571 return "DW_OP_breg19";
2572 case DW_OP_breg20:
2573 return "DW_OP_breg20";
2574 case DW_OP_breg21:
2575 return "DW_OP_breg21";
2576 case DW_OP_breg22:
2577 return "DW_OP_breg22";
2578 case DW_OP_breg23:
2579 return "DW_OP_breg23";
2580 case DW_OP_breg24:
2581 return "DW_OP_breg24";
2582 case DW_OP_breg25:
2583 return "DW_OP_breg25";
2584 case DW_OP_breg26:
2585 return "DW_OP_breg26";
2586 case DW_OP_breg27:
2587 return "DW_OP_breg27";
2588 case DW_OP_breg28:
2589 return "DW_OP_breg28";
2590 case DW_OP_breg29:
2591 return "DW_OP_breg29";
2592 case DW_OP_breg30:
2593 return "DW_OP_breg30";
2594 case DW_OP_breg31:
2595 return "DW_OP_breg31";
2596 case DW_OP_regx:
2597 return "DW_OP_regx";
2598 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2599 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
2600 case DW_OP_bregx:
2601 return "DW_OP_bregx";
2602 case DW_OP_piece:
2603 return "DW_OP_piece";
2604 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2605 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
2606 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2607 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
2608 case DW_OP_nop:
2609 return "DW_OP_nop";
2610 default:
2611 return "OP_<unknown>";
2615 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
2616 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
2617 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
2619 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
2620 new_loc_descr (op, oprnd1, oprnd2)
2621 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
2622 unsigned long oprnd1;
2623 unsigned long oprnd2;
2625 /* Use xcalloc here so we clear out all of the long_long constant in
2626 the union. */
2627 dw_loc_descr_ref descr
2628 = (dw_loc_descr_ref) xcalloc (1, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
2630 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
2631 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
2632 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
2633 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
2634 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
2636 return descr;
2640 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
2642 static inline void
2643 add_loc_descr (list_head, descr)
2644 dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head;
2645 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
2647 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
2649 /* Find the end of the chain. */
2650 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
2653 *d = descr;
2656 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
2658 static unsigned long
2659 size_of_loc_descr (loc)
2660 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
2662 unsigned long size = 1;
2664 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2666 case DW_OP_addr:
2667 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
2668 break;
2669 case DW_OP_const1u:
2670 case DW_OP_const1s:
2671 size += 1;
2672 break;
2673 case DW_OP_const2u:
2674 case DW_OP_const2s:
2675 size += 2;
2676 break;
2677 case DW_OP_const4u:
2678 case DW_OP_const4s:
2679 size += 4;
2680 break;
2681 case DW_OP_const8u:
2682 case DW_OP_const8s:
2683 size += 8;
2684 break;
2685 case DW_OP_constu:
2686 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2687 break;
2688 case DW_OP_consts:
2689 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
2690 break;
2691 case DW_OP_pick:
2692 size += 1;
2693 break;
2694 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2695 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2696 break;
2697 case DW_OP_skip:
2698 case DW_OP_bra:
2699 size += 2;
2700 break;
2701 case DW_OP_breg0:
2702 case DW_OP_breg1:
2703 case DW_OP_breg2:
2704 case DW_OP_breg3:
2705 case DW_OP_breg4:
2706 case DW_OP_breg5:
2707 case DW_OP_breg6:
2708 case DW_OP_breg7:
2709 case DW_OP_breg8:
2710 case DW_OP_breg9:
2711 case DW_OP_breg10:
2712 case DW_OP_breg11:
2713 case DW_OP_breg12:
2714 case DW_OP_breg13:
2715 case DW_OP_breg14:
2716 case DW_OP_breg15:
2717 case DW_OP_breg16:
2718 case DW_OP_breg17:
2719 case DW_OP_breg18:
2720 case DW_OP_breg19:
2721 case DW_OP_breg20:
2722 case DW_OP_breg21:
2723 case DW_OP_breg22:
2724 case DW_OP_breg23:
2725 case DW_OP_breg24:
2726 case DW_OP_breg25:
2727 case DW_OP_breg26:
2728 case DW_OP_breg27:
2729 case DW_OP_breg28:
2730 case DW_OP_breg29:
2731 case DW_OP_breg30:
2732 case DW_OP_breg31:
2733 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
2734 break;
2735 case DW_OP_regx:
2736 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2737 break;
2738 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2739 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
2740 break;
2741 case DW_OP_bregx:
2742 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2743 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
2744 break;
2745 case DW_OP_piece:
2746 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2747 break;
2748 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2749 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2750 size += 1;
2751 break;
2752 default:
2753 break;
2756 return size;
2759 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
2761 static unsigned long
2762 size_of_locs (loc)
2763 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
2765 unsigned long size;
2767 for (size = 0; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2769 loc->dw_loc_addr = size;
2770 size += size_of_loc_descr (loc);
2773 return size;
2776 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
2778 static void
2779 output_loc_operands (loc)
2780 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
2782 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2783 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2785 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2787 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2788 case DW_OP_addr:
2789 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
2790 break;
2791 case DW_OP_const2u:
2792 case DW_OP_const2s:
2793 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2794 break;
2795 case DW_OP_const4u:
2796 case DW_OP_const4s:
2797 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2798 break;
2799 case DW_OP_const8u:
2800 case DW_OP_const8s:
2801 if (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG < 64)
2802 abort ();
2803 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2804 break;
2805 case DW_OP_skip:
2806 case DW_OP_bra:
2808 int offset;
2810 if (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
2811 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2812 else
2813 abort ();
2815 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
2817 break;
2818 #else
2819 case DW_OP_addr:
2820 case DW_OP_const2u:
2821 case DW_OP_const2s:
2822 case DW_OP_const4u:
2823 case DW_OP_const4s:
2824 case DW_OP_const8u:
2825 case DW_OP_const8s:
2826 case DW_OP_skip:
2827 case DW_OP_bra:
2828 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
2829 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
2830 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
2831 only doing unwinding. */
2832 abort ();
2833 #endif
2834 case DW_OP_const1u:
2835 case DW_OP_const1s:
2836 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2837 break;
2838 case DW_OP_constu:
2839 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2840 break;
2841 case DW_OP_consts:
2842 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2843 break;
2844 case DW_OP_pick:
2845 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2846 break;
2847 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2848 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2849 break;
2850 case DW_OP_breg0:
2851 case DW_OP_breg1:
2852 case DW_OP_breg2:
2853 case DW_OP_breg3:
2854 case DW_OP_breg4:
2855 case DW_OP_breg5:
2856 case DW_OP_breg6:
2857 case DW_OP_breg7:
2858 case DW_OP_breg8:
2859 case DW_OP_breg9:
2860 case DW_OP_breg10:
2861 case DW_OP_breg11:
2862 case DW_OP_breg12:
2863 case DW_OP_breg13:
2864 case DW_OP_breg14:
2865 case DW_OP_breg15:
2866 case DW_OP_breg16:
2867 case DW_OP_breg17:
2868 case DW_OP_breg18:
2869 case DW_OP_breg19:
2870 case DW_OP_breg20:
2871 case DW_OP_breg21:
2872 case DW_OP_breg22:
2873 case DW_OP_breg23:
2874 case DW_OP_breg24:
2875 case DW_OP_breg25:
2876 case DW_OP_breg26:
2877 case DW_OP_breg27:
2878 case DW_OP_breg28:
2879 case DW_OP_breg29:
2880 case DW_OP_breg30:
2881 case DW_OP_breg31:
2882 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2883 break;
2884 case DW_OP_regx:
2885 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2886 break;
2887 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2888 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2889 break;
2890 case DW_OP_bregx:
2891 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2892 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2893 break;
2894 case DW_OP_piece:
2895 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2896 break;
2897 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2898 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2899 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2900 break;
2901 default:
2902 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2903 break;
2907 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
2909 static void
2910 output_loc_sequence (loc)
2911 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
2913 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2915 /* Output the opcode. */
2916 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
2917 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
2919 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
2920 output_loc_operands (loc);
2924 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
2925 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
2927 static void
2928 output_cfa_loc (cfi)
2929 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
2931 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
2932 unsigned long size;
2934 /* Output the size of the block. */
2935 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
2936 size = size_of_locs (loc);
2937 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
2939 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
2940 output_loc_sequence (loc);
2943 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from
2944 a dw_cfa_location. */
2946 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
2947 build_cfa_loc (cfa)
2948 dw_cfa_location *cfa;
2950 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
2952 if (cfa->indirect == 0)
2953 abort ();
2955 if (cfa->base_offset)
2957 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
2958 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
2959 else
2960 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
2962 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
2963 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
2964 else
2965 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
2967 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
2968 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
2969 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2970 if (cfa->offset != 0)
2972 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, cfa->offset, 0);
2973 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2976 return head;
2979 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
2980 descriptor sequence. */
2982 static void
2983 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (cfa, loc)
2984 dw_cfa_location *cfa;
2985 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc;
2987 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
2988 cfa->offset = 0;
2989 cfa->base_offset = 0;
2990 cfa->indirect = 0;
2991 cfa->reg = -1;
2993 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
2995 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
2997 switch (op)
2999 case DW_OP_reg0:
3000 case DW_OP_reg1:
3001 case DW_OP_reg2:
3002 case DW_OP_reg3:
3003 case DW_OP_reg4:
3004 case DW_OP_reg5:
3005 case DW_OP_reg6:
3006 case DW_OP_reg7:
3007 case DW_OP_reg8:
3008 case DW_OP_reg9:
3009 case DW_OP_reg10:
3010 case DW_OP_reg11:
3011 case DW_OP_reg12:
3012 case DW_OP_reg13:
3013 case DW_OP_reg14:
3014 case DW_OP_reg15:
3015 case DW_OP_reg16:
3016 case DW_OP_reg17:
3017 case DW_OP_reg18:
3018 case DW_OP_reg19:
3019 case DW_OP_reg20:
3020 case DW_OP_reg21:
3021 case DW_OP_reg22:
3022 case DW_OP_reg23:
3023 case DW_OP_reg24:
3024 case DW_OP_reg25:
3025 case DW_OP_reg26:
3026 case DW_OP_reg27:
3027 case DW_OP_reg28:
3028 case DW_OP_reg29:
3029 case DW_OP_reg30:
3030 case DW_OP_reg31:
3031 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
3032 break;
3033 case DW_OP_regx:
3034 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3035 break;
3036 case DW_OP_breg0:
3037 case DW_OP_breg1:
3038 case DW_OP_breg2:
3039 case DW_OP_breg3:
3040 case DW_OP_breg4:
3041 case DW_OP_breg5:
3042 case DW_OP_breg6:
3043 case DW_OP_breg7:
3044 case DW_OP_breg8:
3045 case DW_OP_breg9:
3046 case DW_OP_breg10:
3047 case DW_OP_breg11:
3048 case DW_OP_breg12:
3049 case DW_OP_breg13:
3050 case DW_OP_breg14:
3051 case DW_OP_breg15:
3052 case DW_OP_breg16:
3053 case DW_OP_breg17:
3054 case DW_OP_breg18:
3055 case DW_OP_breg19:
3056 case DW_OP_breg20:
3057 case DW_OP_breg21:
3058 case DW_OP_breg22:
3059 case DW_OP_breg23:
3060 case DW_OP_breg24:
3061 case DW_OP_breg25:
3062 case DW_OP_breg26:
3063 case DW_OP_breg27:
3064 case DW_OP_breg28:
3065 case DW_OP_breg29:
3066 case DW_OP_breg30:
3067 case DW_OP_breg31:
3068 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
3069 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3070 break;
3071 case DW_OP_bregx:
3072 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3073 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
3074 break;
3075 case DW_OP_deref:
3076 cfa->indirect = 1;
3077 break;
3078 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3079 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
3080 break;
3081 default:
3082 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented\n",
3083 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
3087 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
3089 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
3090 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3092 /* .debug_str support. */
3093 static hashnode indirect_string_alloc PARAMS ((hash_table *));
3094 static int output_indirect_string PARAMS ((struct cpp_reader *,
3095 hashnode, const PTR));
3098 static void dwarf2out_init PARAMS ((const char *));
3099 static void dwarf2out_finish PARAMS ((const char *));
3100 static void dwarf2out_define PARAMS ((unsigned int, const char *));
3101 static void dwarf2out_undef PARAMS ((unsigned int, const char *));
3102 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file PARAMS ((unsigned, const char *));
3103 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file PARAMS ((unsigned));
3104 static void dwarf2out_begin_block PARAMS ((unsigned, unsigned));
3105 static void dwarf2out_end_block PARAMS ((unsigned, unsigned));
3106 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block PARAMS ((tree));
3107 static void dwarf2out_global_decl PARAMS ((tree));
3108 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function PARAMS ((tree));
3110 /* The debug hooks structure. */
3112 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
3114 dwarf2out_init,
3115 dwarf2out_finish,
3116 dwarf2out_define,
3117 dwarf2out_undef,
3118 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
3119 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
3120 dwarf2out_begin_block,
3121 dwarf2out_end_block,
3122 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
3123 dwarf2out_source_line,
3124 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
3125 debug_nothing_int, /* end_prologue */
3126 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
3127 debug_nothing_tree, /* begin_function */
3128 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
3129 dwarf2out_decl, /* function_decl */
3130 dwarf2out_global_decl,
3131 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
3132 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3133 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3134 something tries to reference them. */
3135 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
3136 debug_nothing_rtx /* label */
3139 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3140 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3141 throughout the remainder of this file. */
3143 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3144 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
3145 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3146 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
3148 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3149 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
3151 typedef long int dw_offset;
3153 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
3155 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
3156 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
3157 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
3158 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
3159 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
3161 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3162 line number associated with the label generated for that
3163 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
3164 the line number entry. */
3166 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct
3168 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3169 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3171 dw_line_info_entry;
3173 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3174 own sequence. */
3175 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct
3177 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3178 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3179 unsigned long function;
3181 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
3183 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3184 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3185 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
3187 typedef struct dw_attr_struct
3189 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3190 dw_attr_ref dw_attr_next;
3191 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3193 dw_attr_node;
3195 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure */
3197 typedef struct die_struct
3199 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3200 char *die_symbol;
3201 dw_attr_ref die_attr;
3202 dw_die_ref die_parent;
3203 dw_die_ref die_child;
3204 dw_die_ref die_sib;
3205 dw_offset die_offset;
3206 unsigned long die_abbrev;
3207 int die_mark;
3209 die_node;
3211 /* The pubname structure */
3213 typedef struct pubname_struct
3215 dw_die_ref die;
3216 char *name;
3218 pubname_entry;
3220 struct dw_ranges_struct
3222 int block_num;
3225 /* The limbo die list structure. */
3226 typedef struct limbo_die_struct
3228 dw_die_ref die;
3229 tree created_for;
3230 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3232 limbo_die_node;
3234 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
3235 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3236 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3237 #endif
3239 /* Define a macro which returns non-zero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3240 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3242 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3243 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3244 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3245 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3246 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3247 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
3249 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3250 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3251 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3252 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
3253 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3254 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3255 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3256 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3257 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3258 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3260 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3261 language, and compiler version. */
3263 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3264 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3266 /* Fixed size portion of debugging line information prolog. */
3267 #define DWARF_LINE_PROLOG_HEADER_SIZE 5
3269 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3270 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3272 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3273 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3274 (DWARF_ROUND (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3275 - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
3277 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3278 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3279 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3280 (DWARF_ROUND (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3281 - (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3283 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3284 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3285 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3286 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3287 #else
3288 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3289 #endif
3290 #endif
3292 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3293 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3294 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3296 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3297 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
3299 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3300 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3302 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3303 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3304 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3305 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3306 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3308 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3309 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3310 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3312 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3313 static dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
3315 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3316 static limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list = 0;
3318 /* Structure used by lookup_filename to manage sets of filenames. */
3319 struct file_table
3321 char **table;
3322 unsigned allocated;
3323 unsigned in_use;
3324 unsigned last_lookup_index;
3327 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the filename
3328 table. */
3329 #define FILE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3331 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3332 static struct file_table file_table;
3334 /* Local pointer to the name of the main input file. Initialized in
3335 dwarf2out_init. */
3336 static const char *primary_filename;
3338 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to DIE's that describe
3339 declarations. The table is indexed by DECL_UID() which is a unique
3340 number identifying each decl. */
3341 static dw_die_ref *decl_die_table;
3343 /* Number of elements currently allocated for the decl_die_table. */
3344 static unsigned decl_die_table_allocated;
3346 /* Number of elements in decl_die_table currently in use. */
3347 static unsigned decl_die_table_in_use;
3349 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3350 decl_die_table. */
3351 #define DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3353 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
3354 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
3355 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
3356 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
3357 define type declaration DIE's. */
3358 varray_type decl_scope_table;
3360 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3361 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3362 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3363 static dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3365 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
3366 static unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3368 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
3369 static unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3371 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3372 abbrev_die_table. */
3373 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3375 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3376 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
3377 static dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
3379 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
3380 static unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
3382 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
3383 static unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
3385 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3386 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
3387 static dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
3389 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
3390 static unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
3392 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
3393 static unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
3395 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3396 line_info_table. */
3397 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
3399 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3400 accessible names. */
3401 static pubname_ref pubname_table;
3403 /* Number of elements currently allocated for pubname_table. */
3404 static unsigned pubname_table_allocated;
3406 /* Number of elements in pubname_table currently in use. */
3407 static unsigned pubname_table_in_use;
3409 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3410 pubname_table. */
3411 #define PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3413 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
3414 static dw_die_ref *arange_table;
3416 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
3417 static unsigned arange_table_allocated;
3419 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
3420 static unsigned arange_table_in_use;
3422 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3423 arange_table. */
3424 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3426 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3427 static dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
3429 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
3430 static unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3432 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
3433 static unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3435 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3436 ranges_table. */
3437 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3439 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3440 static unsigned have_location_lists;
3442 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
3443 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a VARRAY
3444 because we want to tell the garbage collector about it. */
3445 varray_type incomplete_types;
3447 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
3448 static int current_function_has_inlines;
3449 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
3450 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
3451 #endif
3453 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
3454 must be kept around forever. This is a GC root. */
3455 static varray_type used_rtx_varray;
3457 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
3459 static int is_pseudo_reg PARAMS ((rtx));
3460 static tree type_main_variant PARAMS ((tree));
3461 static int is_tagged_type PARAMS ((tree));
3462 static const char *dwarf_tag_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
3463 static const char *dwarf_attr_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
3464 static const char *dwarf_form_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
3465 #if 0
3466 static const char *dwarf_type_encoding_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
3467 #endif
3468 static tree decl_ultimate_origin PARAMS ((tree));
3469 static tree block_ultimate_origin PARAMS ((tree));
3470 static tree decl_class_context PARAMS ((tree));
3471 static void add_dwarf_attr PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref));
3472 static inline dw_val_class AT_class PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3473 static void add_AT_flag PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3474 enum dwarf_attribute,
3475 unsigned));
3476 static inline unsigned AT_flag PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3477 static void add_AT_int PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3478 enum dwarf_attribute, long));
3479 static inline long int AT_int PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3480 static void add_AT_unsigned PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3481 enum dwarf_attribute,
3482 unsigned long));
3483 static inline unsigned long AT_unsigned PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3484 static void add_AT_long_long PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3485 enum dwarf_attribute,
3486 unsigned long,
3487 unsigned long));
3488 static void add_AT_float PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3489 enum dwarf_attribute,
3490 unsigned, long *));
3491 static void add_AT_string PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3492 enum dwarf_attribute,
3493 const char *));
3494 static inline const char *AT_string PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3495 static int AT_string_form PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3496 static void add_AT_die_ref PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3497 enum dwarf_attribute,
3498 dw_die_ref));
3499 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3500 static inline int AT_ref_external PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3501 static inline void set_AT_ref_external PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref, int));
3502 static void add_AT_fde_ref PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3503 enum dwarf_attribute,
3504 unsigned));
3505 static void add_AT_loc PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3506 enum dwarf_attribute,
3507 dw_loc_descr_ref));
3508 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3509 static void add_AT_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3510 enum dwarf_attribute,
3511 dw_loc_list_ref));
3512 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3513 static void add_AT_addr PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3514 enum dwarf_attribute,
3515 rtx));
3516 static inline rtx AT_addr PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3517 static void add_AT_lbl_id PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3518 enum dwarf_attribute,
3519 const char *));
3520 static void add_AT_lbl_offset PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3521 enum dwarf_attribute,
3522 const char *));
3523 static void add_AT_offset PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3524 enum dwarf_attribute,
3525 unsigned long));
3526 static void add_AT_range_list PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3527 enum dwarf_attribute,
3528 unsigned long));
3529 static inline const char *AT_lbl PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3530 static dw_attr_ref get_AT PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3531 enum dwarf_attribute));
3532 static const char *get_AT_low_pc PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3533 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3534 static const char *get_AT_string PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3535 enum dwarf_attribute));
3536 static int get_AT_flag PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3537 enum dwarf_attribute));
3538 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3539 enum dwarf_attribute));
3540 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3541 enum dwarf_attribute));
3542 static int is_c_family PARAMS ((void));
3543 static int is_cxx PARAMS ((void));
3544 static int is_java PARAMS ((void));
3545 static int is_fortran PARAMS ((void));
3546 static void remove_AT PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3547 enum dwarf_attribute));
3548 static inline void free_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3549 static void remove_children PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3550 static void add_child_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref));
3551 static dw_die_ref new_die PARAMS ((enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref,
3552 tree));
3553 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die PARAMS ((tree));
3554 static void equate_type_number_to_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3555 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die PARAMS ((tree));
3556 static void equate_decl_number_to_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3557 static void print_spaces PARAMS ((FILE *));
3558 static void print_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, FILE *));
3559 static void print_dwarf_line_table PARAMS ((FILE *));
3560 static void reverse_die_lists PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3561 static void reverse_all_dies PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3562 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref));
3563 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3564 static void loc_checksum PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref,
3565 struct md5_ctx *));
3566 static void attr_checksum PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref,
3567 struct md5_ctx *));
3568 static void die_checksum PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3569 struct md5_ctx *));
3570 static void compute_section_prefix PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3571 static int is_type_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3572 static int is_comdat_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3573 static int is_symbol_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3574 static void assign_symbol_names PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3575 static void break_out_includes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3576 static void add_sibling_attributes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3577 static void build_abbrev_table PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3578 static void output_location_lists PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3579 static int constant_size PARAMS ((long unsigned));
3580 static unsigned long size_of_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3581 static void calc_die_sizes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3582 static void mark_dies PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3583 static void unmark_dies PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3584 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames PARAMS ((void));
3585 static unsigned long size_of_aranges PARAMS ((void));
3586 static enum dwarf_form value_format PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3587 static void output_value_format PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3588 static void output_abbrev_section PARAMS ((void));
3589 static void output_die_symbol PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3590 static void output_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3591 static void output_compilation_unit_header PARAMS ((void));
3592 static void output_comp_unit PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3593 static const char *dwarf2_name PARAMS ((tree, int));
3594 static void add_pubname PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3595 static void output_pubnames PARAMS ((void));
3596 static void add_arange PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3597 static void output_aranges PARAMS ((void));
3598 static unsigned int add_ranges PARAMS ((tree));
3599 static void output_ranges PARAMS ((void));
3600 static void output_line_info PARAMS ((void));
3601 static void output_file_names PARAMS ((void));
3602 static dw_die_ref base_type_die PARAMS ((tree));
3603 static tree root_type PARAMS ((tree));
3604 static int is_base_type PARAMS ((tree));
3605 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die PARAMS ((tree, int, int, dw_die_ref));
3606 static int type_is_enum PARAMS ((tree));
3607 static unsigned int reg_number PARAMS ((rtx));
3608 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor PARAMS ((rtx));
3609 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor PARAMS ((HOST_WIDE_INT));
3610 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr PARAMS ((unsigned, long));
3611 static int is_based_loc PARAMS ((rtx));
3612 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor PARAMS ((rtx, enum machine_mode mode));
3613 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor PARAMS ((rtx, rtx));
3614 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor PARAMS ((rtx));
3615 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree PARAMS ((tree, int));
3616 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling PARAMS ((HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int));
3617 static tree field_type PARAMS ((tree));
3618 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits PARAMS ((tree));
3619 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits PARAMS ((tree));
3620 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits PARAMS ((tree));
3621 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset PARAMS ((tree));
3622 static void add_AT_location_description PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3623 enum dwarf_attribute, rtx));
3624 static void add_data_member_location_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3625 static void add_const_value_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, rtx));
3626 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location PARAMS ((tree));
3627 static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3628 static void tree_add_const_value_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3629 static void add_name_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, const char *));
3630 static void add_bound_info PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3631 enum dwarf_attribute, tree));
3632 static void add_subscript_info PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3633 static void add_byte_size_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3634 static void add_bit_offset_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3635 static void add_bit_size_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3636 static void add_prototyped_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3637 static void add_abstract_origin_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3638 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3639 static void add_src_coords_attributes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3640 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3641 static void push_decl_scope PARAMS ((tree));
3642 static void pop_decl_scope PARAMS ((void));
3643 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3644 static inline int local_scope_p PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3645 static inline int class_scope_p PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3646 static void add_type_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree, int, int,
3647 dw_die_ref));
3648 static const char *type_tag PARAMS ((tree));
3649 static tree member_declared_type PARAMS ((tree));
3650 #if 0
3651 static const char *decl_start_label PARAMS ((tree));
3652 #endif
3653 static void gen_array_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3654 static void gen_set_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3655 #if 0
3656 static void gen_entry_point_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3657 #endif
3658 static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3659 static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3660 static void gen_inlined_union_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3661 static void gen_enumeration_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3662 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3663 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3664 static void gen_formal_types_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3665 static void gen_subprogram_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3666 static void gen_variable_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3667 static void gen_label_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3668 static void gen_lexical_block_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref, int));
3669 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref, int));
3670 static void gen_field_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3671 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3672 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die PARAMS ((const char *));
3673 static void gen_string_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3674 static void gen_inheritance_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3675 static void gen_member_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3676 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3677 static void gen_subroutine_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3678 static void gen_typedef_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3679 static void gen_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3680 static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3681 static void gen_block_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref, int));
3682 static void decls_for_scope PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref, int));
3683 static int is_redundant_typedef PARAMS ((tree));
3684 static void gen_decl_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3685 static unsigned lookup_filename PARAMS ((const char *));
3686 static void init_file_table PARAMS ((void));
3687 static void retry_incomplete_types PARAMS ((void));
3688 static void gen_type_die_for_member PARAMS ((tree, tree, dw_die_ref));
3689 static void splice_child_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref));
3690 static int file_info_cmp PARAMS ((const void *, const void *));
3691 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref,
3692 const char *, const char *,
3693 const char *, unsigned));
3694 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_loc_list_ref *,
3695 dw_loc_descr_ref,
3696 const char *, const char *, const char *));
3697 static void output_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_loc_list_ref));
3698 static char *gen_internal_sym PARAMS ((const char *));
3699 static void mark_limbo_die_list PARAMS ((void *));
3701 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
3702 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
3703 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
3704 #endif
3705 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
3706 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
3707 #endif
3708 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
3709 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
3710 #endif
3711 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
3712 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
3713 #endif
3714 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
3715 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
3716 #endif
3717 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
3718 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
3719 #endif
3720 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
3721 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
3722 #endif
3723 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
3724 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
3725 #endif
3726 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
3727 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
3728 #endif
3730 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
3731 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
3732 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
3733 #endif
3735 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
3736 #ifdef HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE
3737 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
3738 (SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1)
3739 #else
3740 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS SECTION_DEBUG
3741 #endif
3743 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
3744 the section names themselves. */
3746 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3747 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
3748 #endif
3749 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3750 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
3751 #endif
3752 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3753 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
3754 #endif
3755 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3756 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
3757 #endif
3758 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
3759 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
3760 #endif
3761 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
3762 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
3763 #endif
3764 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
3765 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
3766 #endif
3768 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
3769 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
3770 options is used and DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
3771 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
3772 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
3774 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3775 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3776 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3777 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3778 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3779 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3780 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3781 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3783 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
3784 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
3785 #endif
3786 #ifndef DATA_END_LABEL
3787 #define DATA_END_LABEL "Ledata"
3788 #endif
3789 #ifndef BSS_END_LABEL
3790 #define BSS_END_LABEL "Lebss"
3791 #endif
3792 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
3793 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
3794 #endif
3795 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
3796 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
3797 #endif
3798 #ifndef BODY_BEGIN_LABEL
3799 #define BODY_BEGIN_LABEL "Lbb"
3800 #endif
3801 #ifndef BODY_END_LABEL
3802 #define BODY_END_LABEL "Lbe"
3803 #endif
3804 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
3805 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
3806 #endif
3807 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
3808 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
3809 #endif
3811 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
3812 called to "demangle" any name before it it put into a DIE. */
3814 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) PARAMS ((const char *));
3816 void
3817 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (func)
3818 const char *(*func) PARAMS ((const char *));
3820 demangle_name_func = func;
3823 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
3825 static inline int
3826 is_pseudo_reg (rtl)
3827 rtx rtl;
3829 return ((GET_CODE (rtl) == REG && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3830 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
3831 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
3834 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
3835 removed. */
3837 static inline tree
3838 type_main_variant (type)
3839 tree type;
3841 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3843 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
3844 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
3845 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
3846 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
3847 here. */
3848 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
3849 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
3850 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3852 return type;
3855 /* Return non-zero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
3857 static inline int
3858 is_tagged_type (type)
3859 tree type;
3861 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
3863 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
3864 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
3867 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
3869 static const char *
3870 dwarf_tag_name (tag)
3871 unsigned tag;
3873 switch (tag)
3875 case DW_TAG_padding:
3876 return "DW_TAG_padding";
3877 case DW_TAG_array_type:
3878 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
3879 case DW_TAG_class_type:
3880 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
3881 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
3882 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
3883 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
3884 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
3885 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
3886 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
3887 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
3888 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
3889 case DW_TAG_label:
3890 return "DW_TAG_label";
3891 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
3892 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
3893 case DW_TAG_member:
3894 return "DW_TAG_member";
3895 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
3896 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
3897 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
3898 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
3899 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
3900 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
3901 case DW_TAG_string_type:
3902 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
3903 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
3904 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
3905 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
3906 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
3907 case DW_TAG_typedef:
3908 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
3909 case DW_TAG_union_type:
3910 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
3911 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
3912 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
3913 case DW_TAG_variant:
3914 return "DW_TAG_variant";
3915 case DW_TAG_common_block:
3916 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
3917 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
3918 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
3919 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
3920 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
3921 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
3922 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
3923 case DW_TAG_module:
3924 return "DW_TAG_module";
3925 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
3926 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
3927 case DW_TAG_set_type:
3928 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
3929 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
3930 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
3931 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
3932 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
3933 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
3934 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
3935 case DW_TAG_base_type:
3936 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
3937 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
3938 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
3939 case DW_TAG_const_type:
3940 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
3941 case DW_TAG_constant:
3942 return "DW_TAG_constant";
3943 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
3944 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
3945 case DW_TAG_file_type:
3946 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
3947 case DW_TAG_friend:
3948 return "DW_TAG_friend";
3949 case DW_TAG_namelist:
3950 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
3951 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
3952 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
3953 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
3954 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
3955 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
3956 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
3957 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
3958 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
3959 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
3960 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
3961 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
3962 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
3963 case DW_TAG_try_block:
3964 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
3965 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
3966 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
3967 case DW_TAG_variable:
3968 return "DW_TAG_variable";
3969 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
3970 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
3971 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
3972 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
3973 case DW_TAG_format_label:
3974 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
3975 case DW_TAG_function_template:
3976 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
3977 case DW_TAG_class_template:
3978 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
3979 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
3980 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
3981 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
3982 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
3983 default:
3984 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
3988 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
3990 static const char *
3991 dwarf_attr_name (attr)
3992 unsigned attr;
3994 switch (attr)
3996 case DW_AT_sibling:
3997 return "DW_AT_sibling";
3998 case DW_AT_location:
3999 return "DW_AT_location";
4000 case DW_AT_name:
4001 return "DW_AT_name";
4002 case DW_AT_ordering:
4003 return "DW_AT_ordering";
4004 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
4005 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
4006 case DW_AT_byte_size:
4007 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
4008 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
4009 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
4010 case DW_AT_bit_size:
4011 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
4012 case DW_AT_element_list:
4013 return "DW_AT_element_list";
4014 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
4015 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
4016 case DW_AT_low_pc:
4017 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
4018 case DW_AT_high_pc:
4019 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
4020 case DW_AT_language:
4021 return "DW_AT_language";
4022 case DW_AT_member:
4023 return "DW_AT_member";
4024 case DW_AT_discr:
4025 return "DW_AT_discr";
4026 case DW_AT_discr_value:
4027 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4028 case DW_AT_visibility:
4029 return "DW_AT_visibility";
4030 case DW_AT_import:
4031 return "DW_AT_import";
4032 case DW_AT_string_length:
4033 return "DW_AT_string_length";
4034 case DW_AT_common_reference:
4035 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4036 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
4037 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4038 case DW_AT_const_value:
4039 return "DW_AT_const_value";
4040 case DW_AT_containing_type:
4041 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4042 case DW_AT_default_value:
4043 return "DW_AT_default_value";
4044 case DW_AT_inline:
4045 return "DW_AT_inline";
4046 case DW_AT_is_optional:
4047 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4048 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
4049 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4050 case DW_AT_producer:
4051 return "DW_AT_producer";
4052 case DW_AT_prototyped:
4053 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4054 case DW_AT_return_addr:
4055 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4056 case DW_AT_start_scope:
4057 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4058 case DW_AT_stride_size:
4059 return "DW_AT_stride_size";
4060 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
4061 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4062 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
4063 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4064 case DW_AT_accessibility:
4065 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4066 case DW_AT_address_class:
4067 return "DW_AT_address_class";
4068 case DW_AT_artificial:
4069 return "DW_AT_artificial";
4070 case DW_AT_base_types:
4071 return "DW_AT_base_types";
4072 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
4073 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4074 case DW_AT_count:
4075 return "DW_AT_count";
4076 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
4077 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4078 case DW_AT_decl_column:
4079 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4080 case DW_AT_decl_file:
4081 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4082 case DW_AT_decl_line:
4083 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4084 case DW_AT_declaration:
4085 return "DW_AT_declaration";
4086 case DW_AT_discr_list:
4087 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4088 case DW_AT_encoding:
4089 return "DW_AT_encoding";
4090 case DW_AT_external:
4091 return "DW_AT_external";
4092 case DW_AT_frame_base:
4093 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4094 case DW_AT_friend:
4095 return "DW_AT_friend";
4096 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
4097 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4098 case DW_AT_macro_info:
4099 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4100 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
4101 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4102 case DW_AT_priority:
4103 return "DW_AT_priority";
4104 case DW_AT_segment:
4105 return "DW_AT_segment";
4106 case DW_AT_specification:
4107 return "DW_AT_specification";
4108 case DW_AT_static_link:
4109 return "DW_AT_static_link";
4110 case DW_AT_type:
4111 return "DW_AT_type";
4112 case DW_AT_use_location:
4113 return "DW_AT_use_location";
4114 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
4115 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4116 case DW_AT_virtuality:
4117 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4118 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
4119 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4121 case DW_AT_allocated:
4122 return "DW_AT_allocated";
4123 case DW_AT_associated:
4124 return "DW_AT_associated";
4125 case DW_AT_data_location:
4126 return "DW_AT_data_location";
4127 case DW_AT_stride:
4128 return "DW_AT_stride";
4129 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
4130 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4131 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
4132 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4133 case DW_AT_extension:
4134 return "DW_AT_extension";
4135 case DW_AT_ranges:
4136 return "DW_AT_ranges";
4137 case DW_AT_trampoline:
4138 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4139 case DW_AT_call_column:
4140 return "DW_AT_call_column";
4141 case DW_AT_call_file:
4142 return "DW_AT_call_file";
4143 case DW_AT_call_line:
4144 return "DW_AT_call_line";
4146 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
4147 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4148 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
4149 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4150 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
4151 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4152 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
4153 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4154 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4155 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4156 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
4157 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4158 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
4159 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4160 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4161 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4162 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
4163 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4164 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
4165 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4166 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
4167 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4169 case DW_AT_sf_names:
4170 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4171 case DW_AT_src_info:
4172 return "DW_AT_src_info";
4173 case DW_AT_mac_info:
4174 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4175 case DW_AT_src_coords:
4176 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4177 case DW_AT_body_begin:
4178 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4179 case DW_AT_body_end:
4180 return "DW_AT_body_end";
4181 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
4182 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
4184 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
4185 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4187 default:
4188 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4192 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4194 static const char *
4195 dwarf_form_name (form)
4196 unsigned form;
4198 switch (form)
4200 case DW_FORM_addr:
4201 return "DW_FORM_addr";
4202 case DW_FORM_block2:
4203 return "DW_FORM_block2";
4204 case DW_FORM_block4:
4205 return "DW_FORM_block4";
4206 case DW_FORM_data2:
4207 return "DW_FORM_data2";
4208 case DW_FORM_data4:
4209 return "DW_FORM_data4";
4210 case DW_FORM_data8:
4211 return "DW_FORM_data8";
4212 case DW_FORM_string:
4213 return "DW_FORM_string";
4214 case DW_FORM_block:
4215 return "DW_FORM_block";
4216 case DW_FORM_block1:
4217 return "DW_FORM_block1";
4218 case DW_FORM_data1:
4219 return "DW_FORM_data1";
4220 case DW_FORM_flag:
4221 return "DW_FORM_flag";
4222 case DW_FORM_sdata:
4223 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4224 case DW_FORM_strp:
4225 return "DW_FORM_strp";
4226 case DW_FORM_udata:
4227 return "DW_FORM_udata";
4228 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
4229 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4230 case DW_FORM_ref1:
4231 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4232 case DW_FORM_ref2:
4233 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4234 case DW_FORM_ref4:
4235 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4236 case DW_FORM_ref8:
4237 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4238 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
4239 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4240 case DW_FORM_indirect:
4241 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4242 default:
4243 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4247 /* Convert a DWARF type code into its string name. */
4249 #if 0
4250 static const char *
4251 dwarf_type_encoding_name (enc)
4252 unsigned enc;
4254 switch (enc)
4256 case DW_ATE_address:
4257 return "DW_ATE_address";
4258 case DW_ATE_boolean:
4259 return "DW_ATE_boolean";
4260 case DW_ATE_complex_float:
4261 return "DW_ATE_complex_float";
4262 case DW_ATE_float:
4263 return "DW_ATE_float";
4264 case DW_ATE_signed:
4265 return "DW_ATE_signed";
4266 case DW_ATE_signed_char:
4267 return "DW_ATE_signed_char";
4268 case DW_ATE_unsigned:
4269 return "DW_ATE_unsigned";
4270 case DW_ATE_unsigned_char:
4271 return "DW_ATE_unsigned_char";
4272 default:
4273 return "DW_ATE_<unknown>";
4276 #endif
4278 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4279 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4280 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4281 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4282 given block. */
4284 static tree
4285 decl_ultimate_origin (decl)
4286 tree decl;
4288 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4289 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4290 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4291 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4292 return NULL_TREE;
4294 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
4295 if (DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)))
4296 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4297 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4298 abort ();
4299 #endif
4301 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4304 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block. The block may be an inlined
4305 instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4306 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4307 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4308 given block. */
4310 static tree
4311 block_ultimate_origin (block)
4312 tree block;
4314 tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
4316 /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4317 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4318 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4319 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
4320 return NULL_TREE;
4322 if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
4323 return NULL_TREE;
4324 else
4326 tree ret_val;
4327 tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
4331 ret_val = lookahead;
4332 lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
4333 ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
4335 while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
4337 return ret_val;
4341 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4342 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4343 parameter. */
4345 static tree
4346 decl_class_context (decl)
4347 tree decl;
4349 tree context = NULL_TREE;
4351 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4352 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4353 else
4354 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4355 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4357 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4358 context = NULL_TREE;
4360 return context;
4363 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. We build the lists up in reverse
4364 addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
4366 static inline void
4367 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr)
4368 dw_die_ref die;
4369 dw_attr_ref attr;
4371 if (die != NULL && attr != NULL)
4373 attr->dw_attr_next = die->die_attr;
4374 die->die_attr = attr;
4378 static inline dw_val_class
4379 AT_class (a)
4380 dw_attr_ref a;
4382 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4385 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
4387 static inline void
4388 add_AT_flag (die, attr_kind, flag)
4389 dw_die_ref die;
4390 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4391 unsigned flag;
4393 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4395 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4396 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4397 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4398 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4399 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4402 static inline unsigned
4403 AT_flag (a)
4404 dw_attr_ref a;
4406 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag)
4407 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4409 abort ();
4412 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4414 static inline void
4415 add_AT_int (die, attr_kind, int_val)
4416 dw_die_ref die;
4417 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4418 long int int_val;
4420 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4422 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4423 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4424 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4425 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4426 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4429 static inline long int
4430 AT_int (a)
4431 dw_attr_ref a;
4433 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const)
4434 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4436 abort ();
4439 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4441 static inline void
4442 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr_kind, unsigned_val)
4443 dw_die_ref die;
4444 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4445 unsigned long unsigned_val;
4447 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4449 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4450 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4451 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4452 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4453 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4456 static inline unsigned long
4457 AT_unsigned (a)
4458 dw_attr_ref a;
4460 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
4461 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4463 abort ();
4466 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4468 static inline void
4469 add_AT_long_long (die, attr_kind, val_hi, val_low)
4470 dw_die_ref die;
4471 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4472 unsigned long val_hi;
4473 unsigned long val_low;
4475 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4477 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4478 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4479 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
4480 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
4481 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
4482 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4485 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4487 static inline void
4488 add_AT_float (die, attr_kind, length, array)
4489 dw_die_ref die;
4490 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4491 unsigned length;
4492 long *array;
4494 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4496 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4497 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4498 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_float;
4499 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length = length;
4500 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.array = array;
4501 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4504 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
4506 static inline void
4507 add_AT_string (die, attr_kind, str)
4508 dw_die_ref die;
4509 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4510 const char *str;
4512 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4513 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4515 if (! debug_str_hash)
4517 debug_str_hash = ht_create (10);
4518 debug_str_hash->alloc_node = indirect_string_alloc;
4521 node = (struct indirect_string_node *)
4522 ht_lookup (debug_str_hash, (const unsigned char *) str,
4523 strlen (str), HT_ALLOC);
4524 node->refcount++;
4526 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4527 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4528 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4529 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4530 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4533 static inline const char *
4534 AT_string (a)
4535 dw_attr_ref a;
4537 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4538 return (const char *) HT_STR (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->id);
4540 abort ();
4543 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4544 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4546 static int
4547 AT_string_form (a)
4548 dw_attr_ref a;
4550 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4552 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4553 unsigned int len;
4554 extern int const_labelno;
4555 char label[32];
4557 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
4558 if (node->form)
4559 return node->form;
4561 len = HT_LEN (&node->id) + 1;
4563 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
4564 always better to put it inline. */
4565 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
4566 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4568 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
4569 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
4570 single module. */
4571 if ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
4572 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
4573 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4575 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LC", const_labelno);
4576 ++const_labelno;
4577 node->label = xstrdup (label);
4579 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
4582 abort ();
4585 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4587 static inline void
4588 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr_kind, targ_die)
4589 dw_die_ref die;
4590 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4591 dw_die_ref targ_die;
4593 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4595 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4596 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4597 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
4598 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
4599 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4600 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4603 static inline dw_die_ref
4604 AT_ref (a)
4605 dw_attr_ref a;
4607 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4608 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
4610 abort ();
4613 static inline int
4614 AT_ref_external (a)
4615 dw_attr_ref a;
4617 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4618 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
4620 return 0;
4623 static inline void
4624 set_AT_ref_external (a, i)
4625 dw_attr_ref a;
4626 int i;
4628 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4629 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
4630 else
4631 abort ();
4634 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4636 static inline void
4637 add_AT_fde_ref (die, attr_kind, targ_fde)
4638 dw_die_ref die;
4639 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4640 unsigned targ_fde;
4642 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4644 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4645 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4646 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
4647 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
4648 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4651 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
4653 static inline void
4654 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, loc)
4655 dw_die_ref die;
4656 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4657 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
4659 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4661 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4662 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4663 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
4664 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
4665 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4668 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4669 AT_loc (a)
4670 dw_attr_ref a;
4672 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc)
4673 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
4675 abort ();
4678 static inline void
4679 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, loc_list)
4680 dw_die_ref die;
4681 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4682 dw_loc_list_ref loc_list;
4684 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4686 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4687 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4688 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
4689 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
4690 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4691 have_location_lists = 1;
4694 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
4695 AT_loc_list (a)
4696 dw_attr_ref a;
4698 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
4699 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4701 abort ();
4704 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
4706 static inline void
4707 add_AT_addr (die, attr_kind, addr)
4708 dw_die_ref die;
4709 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4710 rtx addr;
4712 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4714 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4715 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4716 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
4717 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
4718 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4721 static inline rtx
4722 AT_addr (a)
4723 dw_attr_ref a;
4725 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr)
4726 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
4728 abort ();
4731 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
4733 static inline void
4734 add_AT_lbl_id (die, attr_kind, lbl_id)
4735 dw_die_ref die;
4736 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4737 const char *lbl_id;
4739 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4741 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4742 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4743 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4744 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
4745 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4748 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE. */
4750 static inline void
4751 add_AT_lbl_offset (die, attr_kind, label)
4752 dw_die_ref die;
4753 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4754 const char *label;
4756 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4758 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4759 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4760 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_offset;
4761 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4762 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4765 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
4767 static inline void
4768 add_AT_offset (die, attr_kind, offset)
4769 dw_die_ref die;
4770 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4771 unsigned long offset;
4773 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4775 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4776 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4777 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
4778 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4779 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4782 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
4784 static void
4785 add_AT_range_list (die, attr_kind, offset)
4786 dw_die_ref die;
4787 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4788 unsigned long offset;
4790 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4792 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4793 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4794 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
4795 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4796 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4799 static inline const char *
4800 AT_lbl (a)
4801 dw_attr_ref a;
4803 if (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4804 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_offset))
4805 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
4807 abort ();
4810 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
4812 static inline dw_attr_ref
4813 get_AT (die, attr_kind)
4814 dw_die_ref die;
4815 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4817 dw_attr_ref a;
4818 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
4820 if (die != NULL)
4822 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
4823 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4824 return a;
4825 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
4826 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
4827 spec = AT_ref (a);
4829 if (spec)
4830 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
4833 return NULL;
4836 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4837 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4838 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4840 static inline const char *
4841 get_AT_low_pc (die)
4842 dw_die_ref die;
4844 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
4846 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4849 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4850 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4851 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4853 static inline const char *
4854 get_AT_hi_pc (die)
4855 dw_die_ref die;
4857 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
4859 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4862 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
4863 NULL if it is not present. */
4865 static inline const char *
4866 get_AT_string (die, attr_kind)
4867 dw_die_ref die;
4868 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4870 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4872 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
4875 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
4876 if it is not present. */
4878 static inline int
4879 get_AT_flag (die, attr_kind)
4880 dw_die_ref die;
4881 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4883 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4885 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
4888 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
4889 if it is not present. */
4891 static inline unsigned
4892 get_AT_unsigned (die, attr_kind)
4893 dw_die_ref die;
4894 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4896 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4898 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
4901 static inline dw_die_ref
4902 get_AT_ref (die, attr_kind)
4903 dw_die_ref die;
4904 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4906 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4908 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
4911 static inline int
4912 is_c_family ()
4914 unsigned lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
4916 return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89
4917 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
4920 static inline int
4921 is_cxx ()
4923 return (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
4924 == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
4927 static inline int
4928 is_fortran ()
4930 unsigned lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
4932 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90);
4935 static inline int
4936 is_java ()
4938 unsigned lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
4940 return (lang == DW_LANG_Java);
4943 /* Free up the memory used by A. */
4945 static inline void free_AT PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
4946 static inline void
4947 free_AT (a)
4948 dw_attr_ref a;
4950 switch (AT_class (a))
4952 case dw_val_class_str:
4953 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
4954 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
4955 break;
4957 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
4958 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
4959 free (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id);
4960 break;
4962 case dw_val_class_float:
4963 free (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.array);
4964 break;
4966 default:
4967 break;
4970 free (a);
4973 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
4975 static void
4976 remove_AT (die, attr_kind)
4977 dw_die_ref die;
4978 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4980 dw_attr_ref *p;
4981 dw_attr_ref removed = NULL;
4983 if (die != NULL)
4985 for (p = &(die->die_attr); *p; p = &((*p)->dw_attr_next))
4986 if ((*p)->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4988 removed = *p;
4989 *p = (*p)->dw_attr_next;
4990 break;
4993 if (removed != 0)
4994 free_AT (removed);
4998 /* Free up the memory used by DIE. */
5000 static inline void
5001 free_die (die)
5002 dw_die_ref die;
5004 remove_children (die);
5005 free (die);
5008 /* Discard the children of this DIE. */
5010 static void
5011 remove_children (die)
5012 dw_die_ref die;
5014 dw_die_ref child_die = die->die_child;
5016 die->die_child = NULL;
5018 while (child_die != NULL)
5020 dw_die_ref tmp_die = child_die;
5021 dw_attr_ref a;
5023 child_die = child_die->die_sib;
5025 for (a = tmp_die->die_attr; a != NULL;)
5027 dw_attr_ref tmp_a = a;
5029 a = a->dw_attr_next;
5030 free_AT (tmp_a);
5033 free_die (tmp_die);
5037 /* Add a child DIE below its parent. We build the lists up in reverse
5038 addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
5040 static inline void
5041 add_child_die (die, child_die)
5042 dw_die_ref die;
5043 dw_die_ref child_die;
5045 if (die != NULL && child_die != NULL)
5047 if (die == child_die)
5048 abort ();
5050 child_die->die_parent = die;
5051 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child;
5052 die->die_child = child_die;
5056 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5057 is the specification, to the front of PARENT's list of children. */
5059 static void
5060 splice_child_die (parent, child)
5061 dw_die_ref parent, child;
5063 dw_die_ref *p;
5065 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5066 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5067 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5069 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5071 if (tmp)
5072 child = tmp;
5075 if (child->die_parent != parent
5076 && child->die_parent != get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification))
5077 abort ();
5079 for (p = &(child->die_parent->die_child); *p; p = &((*p)->die_sib))
5080 if (*p == child)
5082 *p = child->die_sib;
5083 break;
5086 child->die_sib = parent->die_child;
5087 parent->die_child = child;
5090 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
5092 static inline dw_die_ref
5093 new_die (tag_value, parent_die, t)
5094 enum dwarf_tag tag_value;
5095 dw_die_ref parent_die;
5096 tree t;
5098 dw_die_ref die = (dw_die_ref) xcalloc (1, sizeof (die_node));
5100 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5102 if (parent_die != NULL)
5103 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5104 else
5106 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5108 limbo_node = (limbo_die_node *) xmalloc (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
5109 limbo_node->die = die;
5110 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5111 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5112 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5115 return die;
5118 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5120 static inline dw_die_ref
5121 lookup_type_die (type)
5122 tree type;
5124 return (dw_die_ref) TYPE_SYMTAB_POINTER (type);
5127 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5129 static inline void
5130 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die)
5131 tree type;
5132 dw_die_ref type_die;
5134 TYPE_SYMTAB_POINTER (type) = (char *) type_die;
5137 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5139 static inline dw_die_ref
5140 lookup_decl_die (decl)
5141 tree decl;
5143 unsigned decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5145 return (decl_id < decl_die_table_in_use ? decl_die_table[decl_id] : NULL);
5148 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5150 static void
5151 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die)
5152 tree decl;
5153 dw_die_ref decl_die;
5155 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5156 unsigned int num_allocated;
5158 if (decl_id >= decl_die_table_allocated)
5160 num_allocated
5161 = ((decl_id + 1 + DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT - 1)
5162 / DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT)
5163 * DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
5165 decl_die_table
5166 = (dw_die_ref *) xrealloc (decl_die_table,
5167 sizeof (dw_die_ref) * num_allocated);
5169 memset ((char *) &decl_die_table[decl_die_table_allocated], 0,
5170 (num_allocated - decl_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
5171 decl_die_table_allocated = num_allocated;
5174 if (decl_id >= decl_die_table_in_use)
5175 decl_die_table_in_use = (decl_id + 1);
5177 decl_die_table[decl_id] = decl_die;
5180 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5181 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5182 the DIE internal representation. */
5183 static int print_indent;
5185 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5187 static inline void
5188 print_spaces (outfile)
5189 FILE *outfile;
5191 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5194 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5195 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5197 static void
5198 print_die (die, outfile)
5199 dw_die_ref die;
5200 FILE *outfile;
5202 dw_attr_ref a;
5203 dw_die_ref c;
5205 print_spaces (outfile);
5206 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4lu: %s\n",
5207 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
5208 print_spaces (outfile);
5209 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5210 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %lu\n", die->die_offset);
5212 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5214 print_spaces (outfile);
5215 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5217 switch (AT_class (a))
5219 case dw_val_class_addr:
5220 fprintf (outfile, "address");
5221 break;
5222 case dw_val_class_offset:
5223 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5224 break;
5225 case dw_val_class_loc:
5226 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5227 break;
5228 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5229 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5230 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
5231 break;
5232 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5233 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5234 break;
5235 case dw_val_class_const:
5236 fprintf (outfile, "%ld", AT_int (a));
5237 break;
5238 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5239 fprintf (outfile, "%lu", AT_unsigned (a));
5240 break;
5241 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5242 fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5243 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
5244 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
5245 break;
5246 case dw_val_class_float:
5247 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point constant");
5248 break;
5249 case dw_val_class_flag:
5250 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
5251 break;
5252 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5253 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
5255 if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
5256 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
5257 else
5258 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %lu", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
5260 else
5261 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5262 break;
5263 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5264 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5265 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
5266 break;
5267 case dw_val_class_str:
5268 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
5269 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
5270 else
5271 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5272 break;
5273 default:
5274 break;
5277 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5280 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5282 print_indent += 4;
5283 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5284 print_die (c, outfile);
5286 print_indent -= 4;
5288 if (print_indent == 0)
5289 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5292 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5293 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5295 static void
5296 print_dwarf_line_table (outfile)
5297 FILE *outfile;
5299 unsigned i;
5300 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
5302 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
5303 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
5305 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
5306 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: ", i);
5307 fprintf (outfile, "%-20s", file_table.table[line_info->dw_file_num]);
5308 fprintf (outfile, "%6ld", line_info->dw_line_num);
5309 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5312 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
5315 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
5317 void
5318 debug_dwarf_die (die)
5319 dw_die_ref die;
5321 print_die (die, stderr);
5324 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5325 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5327 void
5328 debug_dwarf ()
5330 print_indent = 0;
5331 print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
5332 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
5333 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
5336 /* We build up the lists of children and attributes by pushing new ones
5337 onto the beginning of the list. Reverse the lists for DIE so that
5338 they are in order of addition. */
5340 static void
5341 reverse_die_lists (die)
5342 dw_die_ref die;
5344 dw_die_ref c, cp, cn;
5345 dw_attr_ref a, ap, an;
5347 for (a = die->die_attr, ap = 0; a; a = an)
5349 an = a->dw_attr_next;
5350 a->dw_attr_next = ap;
5351 ap = a;
5354 die->die_attr = ap;
5356 for (c = die->die_child, cp = 0; c; c = cn)
5358 cn = c->die_sib;
5359 c->die_sib = cp;
5360 cp = c;
5363 die->die_child = cp;
5366 /* reverse_die_lists only reverses the single die you pass it. Since we used to
5367 reverse all dies in add_sibling_attributes, which runs through all the dies,
5368 it would reverse all the dies. Now, however, since we don't call
5369 reverse_die_lists in add_sibling_attributes, we need a routine to
5370 recursively reverse all the dies. This is that routine. */
5372 static void
5373 reverse_all_dies (die)
5374 dw_die_ref die;
5376 dw_die_ref c;
5378 reverse_die_lists (die);
5380 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5381 reverse_all_dies (c);
5384 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
5385 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5386 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
5388 static dw_die_ref
5389 push_new_compile_unit (old_unit, bincl_die)
5390 dw_die_ref old_unit, bincl_die;
5392 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5393 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5395 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5396 return new_unit;
5399 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
5401 static dw_die_ref
5402 pop_compile_unit (old_unit)
5403 dw_die_ref old_unit;
5405 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5407 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5408 return new_unit;
5411 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5412 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5414 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5416 static inline void
5417 loc_checksum (loc, ctx)
5418 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5419 struct md5_ctx *ctx;
5421 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5422 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
5423 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
5426 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5428 static void
5429 attr_checksum (at, ctx)
5430 dw_attr_ref at;
5431 struct md5_ctx *ctx;
5433 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5434 rtx r;
5436 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5438 /* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
5439 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
5440 /* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
5441 the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5442 || at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5443 return;
5445 switch (AT_class (at))
5447 case dw_val_class_const:
5448 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5449 break;
5450 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5451 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5452 break;
5453 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5454 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
5455 break;
5456 case dw_val_class_float:
5457 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_float);
5458 break;
5459 case dw_val_class_flag:
5460 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5461 break;
5462 case dw_val_class_str:
5463 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5464 break;
5466 case dw_val_class_addr:
5467 r = AT_addr (at);
5468 switch (GET_CODE (r))
5470 case SYMBOL_REF:
5471 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5472 break;
5474 default:
5475 abort ();
5477 break;
5479 case dw_val_class_offset:
5480 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5481 break;
5483 case dw_val_class_loc:
5484 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5485 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5486 break;
5488 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5489 if (AT_ref (at)->die_offset)
5490 CHECKSUM (AT_ref (at)->die_offset);
5491 /* FIXME else use target die name or something. */
5493 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5494 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5495 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5496 break;
5498 default:
5499 break;
5503 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
5505 static void
5506 die_checksum (die, ctx)
5507 dw_die_ref die;
5508 struct md5_ctx *ctx;
5510 dw_die_ref c;
5511 dw_attr_ref a;
5513 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
5515 for (a = die->die_attr; a; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5516 attr_checksum (a, ctx);
5518 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5519 die_checksum (c, ctx);
5522 #undef CHECKSUM
5523 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
5525 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
5526 info section. */
5527 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
5529 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
5530 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
5532 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
5533 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
5535 static void
5536 compute_section_prefix (unit_die)
5537 dw_die_ref unit_die;
5539 const char *base = lbasename (get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name));
5540 char *name = (char *) alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
5541 char *p;
5542 int i;
5543 unsigned char checksum[16];
5544 struct md5_ctx ctx;
5546 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
5547 the name filename of the unit. */
5549 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
5550 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx);
5551 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
5553 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
5554 clean_symbol_name (name);
5556 p = name + strlen (name);
5557 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
5559 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
5560 p += 2;
5563 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
5564 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
5567 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
5569 static int
5570 is_type_die (die)
5571 dw_die_ref die;
5573 switch (die->die_tag)
5575 case DW_TAG_array_type:
5576 case DW_TAG_class_type:
5577 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
5578 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
5579 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
5580 case DW_TAG_string_type:
5581 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
5582 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
5583 case DW_TAG_union_type:
5584 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
5585 case DW_TAG_set_type:
5586 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
5587 case DW_TAG_base_type:
5588 case DW_TAG_const_type:
5589 case DW_TAG_file_type:
5590 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
5591 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
5592 return 1;
5593 default:
5594 return 0;
5598 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
5599 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
5600 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
5601 compilations (functions). */
5603 static int
5604 is_comdat_die (c)
5605 dw_die_ref c;
5607 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
5608 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
5609 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
5610 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
5612 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
5613 return 0;
5615 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
5616 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
5617 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
5618 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
5620 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
5622 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
5625 return is_type_die (c);
5628 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
5629 compilation unit. */
5631 static int
5632 is_symbol_die (c)
5633 dw_die_ref c;
5635 return (is_type_die (c)
5636 || (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
5637 && !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification)));
5640 static char *
5641 gen_internal_sym (prefix)
5642 const char *prefix;
5644 char buf[256];
5645 static int label_num;
5647 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
5648 return xstrdup (buf);
5651 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
5653 static void
5654 assign_symbol_names (die)
5655 dw_die_ref die;
5657 dw_die_ref c;
5659 if (is_symbol_die (die))
5661 if (comdat_symbol_id)
5663 char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
5665 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
5666 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
5667 die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
5669 else
5670 die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
5673 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5674 assign_symbol_names (c);
5677 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
5678 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
5679 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
5681 static void
5682 break_out_includes (die)
5683 dw_die_ref die;
5685 dw_die_ref *ptr;
5686 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
5687 limbo_die_node *node;
5689 for (ptr = &(die->die_child); *ptr;)
5691 dw_die_ref c = *ptr;
5693 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
5694 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
5696 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
5697 *ptr = c->die_sib;
5699 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
5701 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
5702 free_die (c);
5704 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
5706 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
5707 free_die (c);
5709 else
5710 add_child_die (unit, c);
5712 else
5714 /* Leave this DIE in the main CU. */
5715 ptr = &(c->die_sib);
5716 continue;
5720 #if 0
5721 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
5722 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
5723 if (unit != NULL)
5724 abort ();
5725 #endif
5727 assign_symbol_names (die);
5728 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
5730 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
5731 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
5735 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
5736 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
5737 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
5739 static void
5740 add_sibling_attributes (die)
5741 dw_die_ref die;
5743 dw_die_ref c;
5745 if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
5746 && die->die_sib && die->die_child != NULL)
5747 /* Add the sibling link to the front of the attribute list. */
5748 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
5750 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5751 add_sibling_attributes (c);
5754 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
5756 static void
5757 output_location_lists (die)
5758 dw_die_ref die;
5760 dw_die_ref c;
5761 dw_attr_ref d_attr;
5763 for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
5764 if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
5765 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (d_attr));
5767 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5768 output_location_lists (c);
5772 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
5773 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
5774 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
5775 die are visited recursively. */
5777 static void
5778 build_abbrev_table (die)
5779 dw_die_ref die;
5781 unsigned long abbrev_id;
5782 unsigned int n_alloc;
5783 dw_die_ref c;
5784 dw_attr_ref d_attr, a_attr;
5786 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
5787 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
5788 for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
5789 if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_die_ref
5790 && AT_ref (d_attr)->die_mark == 0)
5792 if (AT_ref (d_attr)->die_symbol == 0)
5793 abort ();
5795 set_AT_ref_external (d_attr, 1);
5798 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
5800 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
5802 if (abbrev->die_tag == die->die_tag)
5804 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) == (die->die_child != NULL))
5806 a_attr = abbrev->die_attr;
5807 d_attr = die->die_attr;
5809 while (a_attr != NULL && d_attr != NULL)
5811 if ((a_attr->dw_attr != d_attr->dw_attr)
5812 || (value_format (a_attr) != value_format (d_attr)))
5813 break;
5815 a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next;
5816 d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next;
5819 if (a_attr == NULL && d_attr == NULL)
5820 break;
5825 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
5827 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
5829 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
5830 abbrev_die_table
5831 = (dw_die_ref *) xrealloc (abbrev_die_table,
5832 sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
5834 memset ((char *) &abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
5835 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
5836 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
5839 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
5840 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
5843 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
5844 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5845 build_abbrev_table (c);
5848 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
5850 static int
5851 constant_size (value)
5852 long unsigned value;
5854 int log;
5856 if (value == 0)
5857 log = 0;
5858 else
5859 log = floor_log2 (value);
5861 log = log / 8;
5862 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
5864 return log;
5867 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
5868 .debug_info section. */
5870 static unsigned long
5871 size_of_die (die)
5872 dw_die_ref die;
5874 unsigned long size = 0;
5875 dw_attr_ref a;
5877 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
5878 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5880 switch (AT_class (a))
5882 case dw_val_class_addr:
5883 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
5884 break;
5885 case dw_val_class_offset:
5886 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5887 break;
5888 case dw_val_class_loc:
5890 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
5892 /* Block length. */
5893 size += constant_size (lsize);
5894 size += lsize;
5896 break;
5897 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5898 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5899 break;
5900 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5901 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5902 break;
5903 case dw_val_class_const:
5904 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
5905 break;
5906 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5907 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
5908 break;
5909 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5910 size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
5911 break;
5912 case dw_val_class_float:
5913 size += 1 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length * 4; /* block */
5914 break;
5915 case dw_val_class_flag:
5916 size += 1;
5917 break;
5918 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5919 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5920 break;
5921 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5922 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5923 break;
5924 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5925 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
5926 break;
5927 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5928 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5929 break;
5930 case dw_val_class_str:
5931 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
5932 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5933 else
5934 size += HT_LEN (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->id) + 1;
5935 break;
5936 default:
5937 abort ();
5941 return size;
5944 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
5945 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
5946 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
5947 die_offset field in each DIE. */
5949 static void
5950 calc_die_sizes (die)
5951 dw_die_ref die;
5953 dw_die_ref c;
5955 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
5956 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
5958 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5959 calc_die_sizes (c);
5961 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5962 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
5963 next_die_offset += 1;
5966 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
5967 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
5968 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
5969 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
5971 static void
5972 mark_dies (die)
5973 dw_die_ref die;
5975 dw_die_ref c;
5977 die->die_mark = 1;
5978 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5979 mark_dies (c);
5982 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
5984 static void
5985 unmark_dies (die)
5986 dw_die_ref die;
5988 dw_die_ref c;
5990 die->die_mark = 0;
5991 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5992 unmark_dies (c);
5995 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames table generated for the
5996 compilation unit. */
5998 static unsigned long
5999 size_of_pubnames ()
6001 unsigned long size;
6002 unsigned i;
6004 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
6005 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
6007 pubname_ref p = &pubname_table[i];
6008 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + strlen (p->name) + 1;
6011 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6012 return size;
6015 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
6017 static unsigned long
6018 size_of_aranges ()
6020 unsigned long size;
6022 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
6024 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
6025 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6026 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
6028 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
6029 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6030 return size;
6033 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
6035 static enum dwarf_form
6036 value_format (a)
6037 dw_attr_ref a;
6039 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
6041 case dw_val_class_addr:
6042 return DW_FORM_addr;
6043 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6044 case dw_val_class_offset:
6045 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
6046 return DW_FORM_data4;
6047 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
6048 return DW_FORM_data8;
6049 abort ();
6050 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6051 /* FIXME: Could be DW_FORM_data8, with a > 32 bit size
6052 .debug_loc section */
6053 return DW_FORM_data4;
6054 case dw_val_class_loc:
6055 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
6057 case 1:
6058 return DW_FORM_block1;
6059 case 2:
6060 return DW_FORM_block2;
6061 default:
6062 abort ();
6064 case dw_val_class_const:
6065 return DW_FORM_sdata;
6066 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6067 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
6069 case 1:
6070 return DW_FORM_data1;
6071 case 2:
6072 return DW_FORM_data2;
6073 case 4:
6074 return DW_FORM_data4;
6075 case 8:
6076 return DW_FORM_data8;
6077 default:
6078 abort ();
6080 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6081 return DW_FORM_block1;
6082 case dw_val_class_float:
6083 return DW_FORM_block1;
6084 case dw_val_class_flag:
6085 return DW_FORM_flag;
6086 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6087 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6088 return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
6089 else
6090 return DW_FORM_ref;
6091 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6092 return DW_FORM_data;
6093 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6094 return DW_FORM_addr;
6095 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
6096 return DW_FORM_data;
6097 case dw_val_class_str:
6098 return AT_string_form (a);
6100 default:
6101 abort ();
6105 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
6107 static void
6108 output_value_format (a)
6109 dw_attr_ref a;
6111 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
6113 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
6116 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
6117 table. */
6119 static void
6120 output_abbrev_section ()
6122 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6124 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
6126 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6128 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6130 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
6131 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
6132 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
6134 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
6135 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
6136 else
6137 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
6139 for (a_attr = abbrev->die_attr; a_attr != NULL;
6140 a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next)
6142 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
6143 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
6144 output_value_format (a_attr);
6147 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6148 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6151 /* Terminate the table. */
6152 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6155 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
6157 static inline void
6158 output_die_symbol (die)
6159 dw_die_ref die;
6161 char *sym = die->die_symbol;
6163 if (sym == 0)
6164 return;
6166 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
6167 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
6168 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
6169 will break. */
6170 ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6172 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6175 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
6176 expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
6177 this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
6179 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
6180 new_loc_list (expr, begin, end, section, gensym)
6181 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
6182 const char *begin;
6183 const char *end;
6184 const char *section;
6185 unsigned gensym;
6187 dw_loc_list_ref retlist
6188 = (dw_loc_list_ref) xcalloc (1, sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
6190 retlist->begin = begin;
6191 retlist->end = end;
6192 retlist->expr = expr;
6193 retlist->section = section;
6194 if (gensym)
6195 retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
6197 return retlist;
6200 /* Add a location description expression to a location list */
6202 static inline void
6203 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (list_head, descr, begin, end, section)
6204 dw_loc_list_ref *list_head;
6205 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
6206 const char *begin;
6207 const char *end;
6208 const char *section;
6210 dw_loc_list_ref *d;
6212 /* Find the end of the chain. */
6213 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
6216 /* Add a new location list node to the list */
6217 *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
6220 /* Output the location list given to us */
6222 static void
6223 output_loc_list (list_head)
6224 dw_loc_list_ref list_head;
6226 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
6228 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
6230 /* ??? This shouldn't be needed now that we've forced the
6231 compilation unit base address to zero when there is code
6232 in more than one section. */
6233 if (strcmp (curr->section, ".text") == 0)
6235 /* dw2_asm_output_data will mask off any extra bits in the ~0. */
6236 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
6237 "Location list base address specifier fake entry");
6238 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->section,
6239 "Location list base address specifier base");
6242 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
6244 unsigned long size;
6246 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
6247 "Location list begin address (%s)",
6248 list_head->ll_symbol);
6249 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
6250 "Location list end address (%s)",
6251 list_head->ll_symbol);
6252 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
6254 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
6255 if (size > 0xffff)
6256 abort ();
6257 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
6259 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
6262 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0,
6263 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
6264 list_head->ll_symbol);
6265 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0,
6266 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
6267 list_head->ll_symbol);
6270 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
6271 the definitions of each child DIE. */
6273 static void
6274 output_die (die)
6275 dw_die_ref die;
6277 dw_attr_ref a;
6278 dw_die_ref c;
6279 unsigned long size;
6281 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
6282 them to point to. */
6283 if (die->die_symbol)
6284 output_die_symbol (die);
6286 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
6287 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
6289 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
6291 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
6293 switch (AT_class (a))
6295 case dw_val_class_addr:
6296 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
6297 break;
6299 case dw_val_class_offset:
6300 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
6301 "%s", name);
6302 break;
6304 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6306 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
6308 sprintf (p, "+0x%lx", a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6309 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
6310 "%s", name);
6311 *p = '\0';
6313 break;
6315 case dw_val_class_loc:
6316 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6318 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
6319 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
6321 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
6322 break;
6324 case dw_val_class_const:
6325 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
6326 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
6327 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
6328 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
6329 break;
6331 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6332 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
6333 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
6334 break;
6336 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6338 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
6340 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
6341 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
6342 "%s", name);
6344 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
6346 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
6347 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
6349 else
6351 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
6352 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
6355 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
6356 first, "long long constant");
6357 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
6358 second, NULL);
6360 break;
6362 case dw_val_class_float:
6364 unsigned int i;
6366 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length * 4,
6367 "%s", name);
6369 for (i = 0; i < a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length; i++)
6370 dw2_asm_output_data (4, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.array[i],
6371 "fp constant word %u", i);
6372 break;
6375 case dw_val_class_flag:
6376 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
6377 break;
6379 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6381 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
6383 if (sym == 0)
6384 abort ();
6385 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym,
6386 loc_section_label, "%s", name);
6388 break;
6390 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6391 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6393 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
6395 if (sym == 0)
6396 abort ();
6397 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, "%s", name);
6399 else if (AT_ref (a)->die_offset == 0)
6400 abort ();
6401 else
6402 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
6403 "%s", name);
6404 break;
6406 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6408 char l1[20];
6410 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
6411 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
6412 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, "%s", name);
6414 break;
6416 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6417 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
6418 break;
6420 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
6421 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
6422 break;
6424 case dw_val_class_str:
6425 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6426 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
6427 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
6428 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
6429 else
6430 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
6431 break;
6433 default:
6434 abort ();
6438 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6439 output_die (c);
6441 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
6442 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6443 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
6444 die->die_offset);
6447 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
6448 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
6450 static void
6451 output_compilation_unit_header ()
6453 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
6454 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
6455 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
6456 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
6457 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
6458 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
6461 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
6463 static void
6464 output_comp_unit (die)
6465 dw_die_ref die;
6467 const char *secname;
6469 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
6470 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
6471 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
6472 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
6473 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
6474 mark_dies (die);
6476 build_abbrev_table (die);
6478 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
6479 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
6480 calc_die_sizes (die);
6482 if (die->die_symbol)
6484 char *tmp = (char *) alloca (strlen (die->die_symbol) + 24);
6486 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", die->die_symbol);
6487 secname = tmp;
6488 die->die_symbol = NULL;
6490 else
6491 secname = (const char *) DEBUG_INFO_SECTION;
6493 /* Output debugging information. */
6494 named_section_flags (secname, SECTION_DEBUG);
6495 output_compilation_unit_header ();
6496 output_die (die);
6498 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
6499 output_pubnames. */
6500 if (die->die_symbol)
6501 unmark_dies (die);
6504 /* The DWARF2 pubname for a nested thingy looks like "A::f". The
6505 output of lang_hooks.decl_printable_name for C++ looks like
6506 "A::f(int)". Let's drop the argument list, and maybe the scope. */
6508 static const char *
6509 dwarf2_name (decl, scope)
6510 tree decl;
6511 int scope;
6513 return (*lang_hooks.decl_printable_name) (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
6516 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
6518 static void
6519 add_pubname (decl, die)
6520 tree decl;
6521 dw_die_ref die;
6523 pubname_ref p;
6525 if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
6526 return;
6528 if (pubname_table_in_use == pubname_table_allocated)
6530 pubname_table_allocated += PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6531 pubname_table
6532 = (pubname_ref) xrealloc (pubname_table,
6533 (pubname_table_allocated
6534 * sizeof (pubname_entry)));
6537 p = &pubname_table[pubname_table_in_use++];
6538 p->die = die;
6539 p->name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
6542 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
6543 visible names. For now, only generate entries for externally
6544 visible procedures. */
6546 static void
6547 output_pubnames ()
6549 unsigned i;
6550 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames ();
6552 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
6553 "Length of Public Names Info");
6554 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
6555 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
6556 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
6557 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
6558 "Compilation Unit Length");
6560 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
6562 pubname_ref pub = &pubname_table[i];
6564 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
6565 if (pub->die->die_mark == 0)
6566 abort ();
6568 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
6569 "DIE offset");
6571 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
6574 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
6577 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
6579 static void
6580 add_arange (decl, die)
6581 tree decl;
6582 dw_die_ref die;
6584 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
6585 return;
6587 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
6589 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6590 arange_table = (dw_die_ref *)
6591 xrealloc (arange_table, arange_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6594 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
6597 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
6598 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
6599 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
6601 static void
6602 output_aranges ()
6604 unsigned i;
6605 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
6607 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
6608 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
6609 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
6610 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
6611 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
6612 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
6613 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
6615 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
6616 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
6618 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
6619 pointer size. */
6620 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
6621 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
6622 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
6623 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
6626 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
6627 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
6628 text_section_label, "Length");
6630 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
6632 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
6634 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
6635 if (die->die_mark == 0)
6636 abort ();
6638 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
6640 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
6641 "Address");
6642 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
6643 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
6645 else
6647 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
6648 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
6649 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
6650 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
6651 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6653 if (! a || AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_loc)
6654 abort ();
6656 loc = AT_loc (a);
6657 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_addr)
6658 abort ();
6660 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
6661 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
6662 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
6663 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
6664 "Length");
6668 /* Output the terminator words. */
6669 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
6670 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
6673 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
6674 was placed. */
6676 static unsigned int
6677 add_ranges (block)
6678 tree block;
6680 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
6682 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
6684 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6685 ranges_table = (dw_ranges_ref)
6686 xrealloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
6687 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
6690 ranges_table[in_use].block_num = (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
6691 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
6693 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6696 static void
6697 output_ranges ()
6699 unsigned i;
6700 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
6701 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
6703 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
6705 int block_num = ranges_table[i].block_num;
6707 if (block_num)
6709 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6710 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6712 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
6713 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
6715 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
6716 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
6717 base of the text section. */
6718 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use == 0)
6720 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
6721 text_section_label,
6722 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
6723 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
6724 text_section_label, NULL);
6727 /* Otherwise, we add a DW_AT_entry_pc attribute to force the
6728 compilation unit base address to zero, which allows us to
6729 use absolute addresses, and not worry about whether the
6730 target supports cross-section arithmetic. */
6731 else
6733 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
6734 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
6735 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
6738 fmt = NULL;
6740 else
6742 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
6743 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
6744 fmt = start_fmt;
6749 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
6750 struct file_info
6752 char *path; /* Complete file name. */
6753 char *fname; /* File name part. */
6754 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
6755 int file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
6756 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
6759 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
6760 files. */
6761 struct dir_info
6763 char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
6764 int length; /* Path length. */
6765 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
6766 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
6767 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
6768 int used; /* Used in the end? */
6771 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
6772 the directories in the path. */
6774 static int
6775 file_info_cmp (p1, p2)
6776 const void *p1;
6777 const void *p2;
6779 const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
6780 const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
6781 unsigned char *cp1;
6782 unsigned char *cp2;
6784 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
6785 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
6786 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
6787 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
6788 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
6789 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
6790 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
6792 cp1 = (unsigned char *) s1->path;
6793 cp2 = (unsigned char *) s2->path;
6795 while (1)
6797 ++cp1;
6798 ++cp2;
6799 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
6800 if ((cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname)
6801 || (cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname))
6802 return ((cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname)
6803 - (cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname));
6805 /* Character of current path component the same? */
6806 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
6807 return *cp1 - *cp2;
6811 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
6812 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
6813 slowdowns with many input files. */
6815 static void
6816 output_file_names ()
6818 struct file_info *files;
6819 struct dir_info *dirs;
6820 int *saved;
6821 int *savehere;
6822 int *backmap;
6823 int ndirs;
6824 int idx_offset;
6825 int i;
6826 int idx;
6828 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
6829 files = (struct file_info *) alloca (file_table.in_use
6830 * sizeof (struct file_info));
6831 dirs = (struct dir_info *) alloca (file_table.in_use
6832 * sizeof (struct dir_info));
6834 /* Sort the file names. */
6835 for (i = 1; i < (int) file_table.in_use; i++)
6837 char *f;
6839 /* Skip all leading "./". */
6840 f = file_table.table[i];
6841 while (f[0] == '.' && f[1] == '/')
6842 f += 2;
6844 /* Create a new array entry. */
6845 files[i].path = f;
6846 files[i].length = strlen (f);
6847 files[i].file_idx = i;
6849 /* Search for the file name part. */
6850 f = strrchr (f, '/');
6851 files[i].fname = f == NULL ? files[i].path : f + 1;
6854 qsort (files + 1, file_table.in_use - 1, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
6856 /* Find all the different directories used. */
6857 dirs[0].path = files[1].path;
6858 dirs[0].length = files[1].fname - files[1].path;
6859 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
6860 dirs[0].count = 1;
6861 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
6862 dirs[0].used = 0;
6863 files[1].dir_idx = 0;
6864 ndirs = 1;
6866 for (i = 2; i < (int) file_table.in_use; i++)
6867 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
6868 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
6869 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
6871 /* Same directory as last entry. */
6872 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
6873 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
6875 else
6877 int j;
6879 /* This is a new directory. */
6880 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
6881 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
6882 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
6883 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
6884 dirs[ndirs].used = 0;
6885 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
6887 /* Search for a prefix. */
6888 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
6889 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
6890 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
6891 && dirs[j].length > 1
6892 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
6893 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
6894 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
6895 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
6897 ++ndirs;
6900 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
6901 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
6902 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
6903 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
6904 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
6905 results in most cases and never is much off. */
6906 saved = (int *) alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
6907 savehere = (int *) alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
6909 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
6910 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
6912 int j;
6913 int total;
6915 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
6916 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
6917 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
6918 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
6920 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
6922 savehere[j] = 0;
6923 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
6925 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
6926 dirs[j] path. */
6927 int k;
6929 k = dirs[j].prefix;
6930 while (k != -1 && k != i)
6931 k = dirs[k].prefix;
6933 if (k == i)
6935 /* Yes it is. We can possibly safe some memory but
6936 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
6937 dirs[i]. */
6938 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
6939 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
6944 /* Check whether we can safe enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
6945 directory. */
6946 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
6948 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
6949 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
6950 if (savehere[j] > 0)
6952 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
6953 saved[j] = savehere[j];
6955 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
6956 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
6961 /* We have to emit them in the order they appear in the file_table array
6962 since the index is used in the debug info generation. To do this
6963 efficiently we generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
6964 backmap = (int *) alloca (file_table.in_use * sizeof (int));
6965 for (i = 1; i < (int) file_table.in_use; i++)
6967 backmap[files[i].file_idx] = i;
6969 /* Mark this directory as used. */
6970 dirs[dirs[files[i].dir_idx].dir_idx].used = 1;
6973 /* That was it. We are ready to emit the information. First emit the
6974 directory name table. We have to make sure the first actually emitted
6975 directory name has index one; zero is reserved for the current working
6976 directory. Make sure we do not confuse these indices with the one for the
6977 constructed table (even though most of the time they are identical). */
6978 idx = 1;
6979 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
6980 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
6981 if (dirs[i].used != 0)
6983 dirs[i].used = idx++;
6984 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
6985 "Directory Entry: 0x%x", dirs[i].used);
6988 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
6990 /* Correct the index for the current working directory entry if it
6991 exists. */
6992 if (idx_offset == 0)
6993 dirs[0].used = 0;
6995 /* Now write all the file names. */
6996 for (i = 1; i < (int) file_table.in_use; i++)
6998 int file_idx = backmap[i];
6999 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
7001 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
7002 "File Entry: 0x%x", i);
7004 /* Include directory index. */
7005 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dirs[dir_idx].used, NULL);
7007 /* Modification time. */
7008 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7010 /* File length in bytes. */
7011 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7014 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7018 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
7019 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
7021 static void
7022 output_line_info ()
7024 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
7025 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7026 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7027 unsigned opc;
7028 unsigned n_op_args;
7029 unsigned long lt_index;
7030 unsigned long current_line;
7031 long line_offset;
7032 long line_delta;
7033 unsigned long current_file;
7034 unsigned long function;
7036 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
7037 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
7038 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
7039 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
7041 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
7042 "Length of Source Line Info");
7043 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
7045 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7046 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
7047 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
7049 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
7050 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
7051 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
7052 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
7053 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
7054 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
7055 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
7056 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
7057 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
7058 "Minimum Instruction Length");
7060 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
7061 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
7062 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
7063 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
7064 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
7065 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
7066 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
7067 "Special Opcode Base");
7069 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
7071 switch (opc)
7073 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
7074 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
7075 case DW_LNS_set_file:
7076 case DW_LNS_set_column:
7077 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
7078 n_op_args = 1;
7079 break;
7080 default:
7081 n_op_args = 0;
7082 break;
7085 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
7086 opc, n_op_args);
7089 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
7090 output_file_names ();
7091 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
7093 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
7094 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
7095 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
7097 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
7098 a series of state machine operations. */
7099 current_file = 1;
7100 current_line = 1;
7101 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
7102 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
7104 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
7106 #if 0
7107 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
7108 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
7109 prologue. */
7111 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
7112 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
7113 that anything after the last address is this line. */
7114 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7115 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
7116 continue;
7117 #endif
7119 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
7121 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
7122 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
7123 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
7124 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
7125 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
7126 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
7128 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
7129 if (0)
7131 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
7132 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7133 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7134 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7136 else
7138 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
7139 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
7140 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7141 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7142 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7143 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7146 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
7148 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
7149 different from the previous line. */
7150 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
7152 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
7153 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
7154 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
7155 file_table.table[current_file]);
7158 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
7159 that uses the least amount of space. */
7160 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
7162 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
7163 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
7164 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
7165 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
7166 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
7167 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
7168 takes 1 byte. */
7169 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
7170 "line %lu", current_line);
7171 else
7173 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
7174 depending on the value being encoded. */
7175 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
7176 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
7177 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
7178 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7181 else
7182 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
7183 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7186 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
7187 if (0)
7189 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7190 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7191 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7193 else
7195 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7196 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7197 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7198 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
7201 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
7202 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
7203 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
7205 function = 0;
7206 current_file = 1;
7207 current_line = 1;
7208 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
7210 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
7211 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
7213 #if 0
7214 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
7215 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7216 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
7217 && line_info->function == function)
7218 goto cont;
7219 #endif
7221 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
7222 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
7223 to handle it differently. */
7224 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
7225 lt_index);
7226 if (function != line_info->function)
7228 function = line_info->function;
7230 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function */
7231 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7232 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7233 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7234 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7236 else
7238 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
7239 if (0)
7241 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7242 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7243 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7245 else
7247 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7248 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7249 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7250 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7254 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
7256 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
7257 different from the previous line. */
7258 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
7260 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
7261 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
7262 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
7263 file_table.table[current_file]);
7266 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
7267 that uses the least amount of space. */
7268 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
7270 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
7271 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
7272 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
7273 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
7274 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
7275 "line %lu", current_line);
7276 else
7278 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
7279 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
7280 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
7281 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7284 else
7285 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7287 #if 0
7288 cont:
7289 #endif
7291 lt_index++;
7293 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
7294 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
7295 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
7297 current_file = 1;
7298 current_line = 1;
7300 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
7301 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
7302 if (0)
7304 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7305 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7306 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7308 else
7310 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7311 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7312 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7313 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7316 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
7317 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
7318 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
7319 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
7323 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
7324 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
7327 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
7328 a DIE that describes the given type.
7330 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
7331 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
7333 static dw_die_ref
7334 base_type_die (type)
7335 tree type;
7337 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
7338 const char *type_name;
7339 enum dwarf_type encoding;
7340 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
7342 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
7343 return 0;
7345 if (name)
7347 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
7348 name = DECL_NAME (name);
7350 type_name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name);
7352 else
7353 type_name = "__unknown__";
7355 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
7357 case INTEGER_TYPE:
7358 /* Carefully distinguish the C character types, without messing
7359 up if the language is not C. Note that we check only for the names
7360 that contain spaces; other names might occur by coincidence in other
7361 languages. */
7362 if (! (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
7363 && (type == char_type_node
7364 || ! strcmp (type_name, "signed char")
7365 || ! strcmp (type_name, "unsigned char"))))
7367 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (type))
7368 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
7369 else
7370 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
7371 break;
7373 /* else fall through. */
7375 case CHAR_TYPE:
7376 /* GNU Pascal/Ada CHAR type. Not used in C. */
7377 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (type))
7378 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
7379 else
7380 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
7381 break;
7383 case REAL_TYPE:
7384 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
7385 break;
7387 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
7388 a user defined type for it. */
7389 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
7390 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
7391 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
7392 else
7393 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
7394 break;
7396 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
7397 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
7398 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
7399 break;
7401 default:
7402 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
7403 abort ();
7406 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7407 if (demangle_name_func)
7408 type_name = (*demangle_name_func) (type_name);
7410 add_AT_string (base_type_result, DW_AT_name, type_name);
7411 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
7412 int_size_in_bytes (type));
7413 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
7415 return base_type_result;
7418 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a pointer to
7419 the Dwarf "root" type for the given input type. The Dwarf "root" type of
7420 a given type is generally the same as the given type, except that if the
7421 given type is a pointer or reference type, then the root type of the given
7422 type is the root type of the "basis" type for the pointer or reference
7423 type. (This definition of the "root" type is recursive.) Also, the root
7424 type of a `const' qualified type or a `volatile' qualified type is the
7425 root type of the given type without the qualifiers. */
7427 static tree
7428 root_type (type)
7429 tree type;
7431 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
7432 return error_mark_node;
7434 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
7436 case ERROR_MARK:
7437 return error_mark_node;
7439 case POINTER_TYPE:
7440 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
7441 return type_main_variant (root_type (TREE_TYPE (type)));
7443 default:
7444 return type_main_variant (type);
7448 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return non-zero if the
7449 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
7451 static inline int
7452 is_base_type (type)
7453 tree type;
7455 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
7457 case ERROR_MARK:
7458 case VOID_TYPE:
7459 case INTEGER_TYPE:
7460 case REAL_TYPE:
7461 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
7462 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
7463 case CHAR_TYPE:
7464 return 1;
7466 case SET_TYPE:
7467 case ARRAY_TYPE:
7468 case RECORD_TYPE:
7469 case UNION_TYPE:
7470 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
7471 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
7472 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
7473 case METHOD_TYPE:
7474 case POINTER_TYPE:
7475 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
7476 case FILE_TYPE:
7477 case OFFSET_TYPE:
7478 case LANG_TYPE:
7479 case VECTOR_TYPE:
7480 return 0;
7482 default:
7483 abort ();
7486 return 0;
7489 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
7490 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
7492 static dw_die_ref
7493 modified_type_die (type, is_const_type, is_volatile_type, context_die)
7494 tree type;
7495 int is_const_type;
7496 int is_volatile_type;
7497 dw_die_ref context_die;
7499 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
7500 dw_die_ref mod_type_die = NULL;
7501 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
7502 tree item_type = NULL;
7504 if (code != ERROR_MARK)
7506 tree qualified_type;
7508 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
7509 this type. */
7510 qualified_type
7511 = get_qualified_type (type,
7512 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
7513 | (is_volatile_type
7514 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
7516 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
7517 if (qualified_type)
7519 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
7520 if (mod_type_die)
7521 return mod_type_die;
7524 /* Handle C typedef types. */
7525 if (qualified_type && TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
7526 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL
7527 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)))
7529 tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (qualified_type);
7530 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (type_name);
7532 if (qualified_type == dtype)
7534 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
7535 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
7536 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
7538 else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
7539 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype))
7540 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
7541 type to which it refers. */
7542 mod_type_die
7543 = modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (type_name),
7544 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
7545 context_die);
7547 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
7550 if (mod_type_die)
7551 /* OK. */
7553 else if (is_const_type)
7555 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7556 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
7558 else if (is_volatile_type)
7560 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7561 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
7563 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
7565 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7566 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
7567 #if 0
7568 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, 0);
7569 #endif
7570 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
7572 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
7574 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7575 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
7576 #if 0
7577 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, 0);
7578 #endif
7579 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
7581 else if (is_base_type (type))
7582 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
7583 else
7585 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
7587 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
7588 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
7589 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
7590 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
7591 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
7592 ..._TYPE node. */
7593 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
7594 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
7595 else
7596 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
7597 not the main variant. */
7598 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
7599 if (mod_type_die == NULL)
7600 abort ();
7603 /* We want to equate the qualified type to the die below. */
7604 if (qualified_type)
7605 type = qualified_type;
7608 equate_type_number_to_die (type, mod_type_die);
7609 if (item_type)
7610 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
7611 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
7612 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
7613 types are possible in Ada. */
7614 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
7615 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
7616 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
7617 context_die);
7619 if (sub_die != NULL)
7620 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
7622 return mod_type_die;
7625 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
7626 an enumerated type. */
7628 static inline int
7629 type_is_enum (type)
7630 tree type;
7632 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
7635 /* Return the register number described by a given RTL node. */
7637 static unsigned int
7638 reg_number (rtl)
7639 rtx rtl;
7641 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
7643 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7644 abort ();
7646 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
7649 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
7650 zero if there is no such. */
7652 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7653 reg_loc_descriptor (rtl)
7654 rtx rtl;
7656 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
7657 unsigned reg;
7659 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7660 return 0;
7662 reg = reg_number (rtl);
7663 if (reg <= 31)
7664 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + reg, 0, 0);
7665 else
7666 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, reg, 0);
7668 return loc_result;
7671 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
7673 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7674 int_loc_descriptor (i)
7675 HOST_WIDE_INT i;
7677 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
7679 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
7680 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
7681 if (i >= 0)
7683 if (i <= 31)
7684 op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
7685 else if (i <= 0xff)
7686 op = DW_OP_const1u;
7687 else if (i <= 0xffff)
7688 op = DW_OP_const2u;
7689 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
7690 || i <= 0xffffffff)
7691 op = DW_OP_const4u;
7692 else
7693 op = DW_OP_constu;
7695 else
7697 if (i >= -0x80)
7698 op = DW_OP_const1s;
7699 else if (i >= -0x8000)
7700 op = DW_OP_const2s;
7701 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
7702 || i >= -0x80000000)
7703 op = DW_OP_const4s;
7704 else
7705 op = DW_OP_consts;
7708 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
7711 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
7713 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7714 based_loc_descr (reg, offset)
7715 unsigned reg;
7716 long int offset;
7718 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
7719 /* For the "frame base", we use the frame pointer or stack pointer
7720 registers, since the RTL for local variables is relative to one of
7721 them. */
7722 unsigned fp_reg = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (frame_pointer_needed
7723 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
7724 : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
7726 if (reg == fp_reg)
7727 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
7728 else if (reg <= 31)
7729 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + reg, offset, 0);
7730 else
7731 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
7733 return loc_result;
7736 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
7738 static inline int
7739 is_based_loc (rtl)
7740 rtx rtl;
7742 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
7743 && ((GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == REG
7744 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7745 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
7748 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
7749 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
7750 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
7751 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
7753 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
7754 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
7755 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
7756 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
7758 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
7759 autoincrement addressing modes.
7761 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
7763 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7764 mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode)
7765 rtx rtl;
7766 enum machine_mode mode;
7768 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
7770 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
7771 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
7772 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
7773 zeroth element of the array. */
7775 #ifdef ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR
7776 rtl = ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR (rtl);
7777 #endif
7779 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
7781 case POST_INC:
7782 case POST_DEC:
7783 case POST_MODIFY:
7784 /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG. So we
7785 just fall into the SUBREG code. */
7787 /* ... fall through ... */
7789 case SUBREG:
7790 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
7791 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
7792 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
7793 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
7794 contains the given subreg. */
7795 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
7797 /* ... fall through ... */
7799 case REG:
7800 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
7801 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
7802 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
7803 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
7804 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
7805 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
7806 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
7807 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
7808 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
7809 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
7810 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
7811 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
7812 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
7813 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7814 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (reg_number (rtl), 0);
7815 break;
7817 case MEM:
7818 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
7819 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
7820 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
7821 break;
7823 case LABEL_REF:
7824 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
7825 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
7826 pool. */
7827 case CONST:
7828 case SYMBOL_REF:
7829 /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
7830 by a different symbol. */
7831 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
7833 bool marked;
7834 rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
7836 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
7838 rtl = tmp;
7839 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
7840 get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
7841 else
7842 marked = true;
7845 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
7846 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
7847 FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
7848 DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
7849 if (!marked)
7850 return 0;
7853 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
7854 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
7855 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
7856 VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, rtl);
7857 break;
7859 case PRE_MODIFY:
7860 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
7861 PLUS code below. */
7862 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
7863 goto plus;
7865 case PRE_INC:
7866 case PRE_DEC:
7867 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
7868 below. */
7869 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
7870 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
7871 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
7872 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
7874 /* ... fall through ... */
7876 case PLUS:
7877 plus:
7878 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
7879 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (reg_number (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
7880 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
7881 else
7883 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
7884 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
7885 break;
7887 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
7888 && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
7889 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
7890 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
7891 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
7892 else
7894 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
7895 mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode));
7896 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
7897 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
7900 break;
7902 case MULT:
7904 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
7905 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply. */
7906 dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
7907 dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode);
7909 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
7910 break;
7912 mem_loc_result = op0;
7913 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
7914 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
7915 break;
7918 case CONST_INT:
7919 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
7920 break;
7922 case ADDRESSOF:
7923 /* If this is a MEM, return its address. Otherwise, we can't
7924 represent this. */
7925 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == MEM)
7926 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0), mode);
7927 else
7928 return 0;
7930 default:
7931 abort ();
7934 return mem_loc_result;
7937 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
7938 This is typically a complex variable. */
7940 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7941 concat_loc_descriptor (x0, x1)
7942 rtx x0, x1;
7944 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
7945 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0);
7946 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1);
7948 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
7949 return 0;
7951 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
7952 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result,
7953 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece,
7954 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)), 0));
7956 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
7957 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result,
7958 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece,
7959 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)), 0));
7961 return cc_loc_result;
7964 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
7965 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
7966 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
7967 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
7968 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
7970 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
7972 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7973 loc_descriptor (rtl)
7974 rtx rtl;
7976 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
7978 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
7980 case SUBREG:
7981 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
7982 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
7983 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
7984 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
7985 contains the given subreg. */
7986 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
7988 /* ... fall through ... */
7990 case REG:
7991 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl);
7992 break;
7994 case MEM:
7995 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
7996 break;
7998 case CONCAT:
7999 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1));
8000 break;
8002 default:
8003 abort ();
8006 return loc_result;
8009 /* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl. This comes
8010 up particularly with variable length arrays. If ADDRESSP is nonzero, we are
8011 looking for an address. Otherwise, we return a value. If we can't make a
8012 descriptor, return 0. */
8014 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8015 loc_descriptor_from_tree (loc, addressp)
8016 tree loc;
8017 int addressp;
8019 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
8020 int indirect_p = 0;
8021 int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
8022 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8024 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
8025 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
8026 problem... */
8028 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
8030 case ERROR_MARK:
8031 return 0;
8033 case WITH_RECORD_EXPR:
8034 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
8035 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
8036 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
8037 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
8038 the names of types. */
8039 return 0;
8041 case CALL_EXPR:
8042 return 0;
8044 case ADDR_EXPR:
8045 /* We can support this only if we can look through conversions and
8046 find an INDIRECT_EXPR. */
8047 for (loc = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0);
8048 TREE_CODE (loc) == CONVERT_EXPR || TREE_CODE (loc) == NOP_EXPR
8049 || TREE_CODE (loc) == NON_LVALUE_EXPR
8050 || TREE_CODE (loc) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
8051 || TREE_CODE (loc) == SAVE_EXPR;
8052 loc = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
8055 return (TREE_CODE (loc) == INDIRECT_REF
8056 ? loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), addressp)
8057 : 0);
8059 case VAR_DECL:
8060 case PARM_DECL:
8062 rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
8064 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
8065 return 0;
8066 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
8068 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8069 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8070 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8071 indirect_p = 1;
8073 else
8075 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
8077 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM)
8079 indirect_p = 1;
8080 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8083 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
8086 break;
8088 case INDIRECT_REF:
8089 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8090 indirect_p = 1;
8091 break;
8093 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
8094 return loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), addressp);
8096 case NOP_EXPR:
8097 case CONVERT_EXPR:
8098 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
8099 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
8100 case SAVE_EXPR:
8101 return loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), addressp);
8103 case COMPONENT_REF:
8104 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
8105 case ARRAY_REF:
8106 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
8108 tree obj, offset;
8109 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
8110 enum machine_mode mode;
8111 int volatilep;
8113 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
8114 &unsignedp, &volatilep);
8116 if (obj == loc)
8117 return 0;
8119 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (obj, 1);
8120 if (ret == 0
8121 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
8122 return 0;
8124 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
8126 /* Variable offset. */
8127 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree (offset, 0));
8128 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8131 if (!addressp)
8132 indirect_p = 1;
8134 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
8135 if (bytepos > 0)
8136 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
8137 else if (bytepos < 0)
8139 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
8140 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8142 break;
8145 case INTEGER_CST:
8146 if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
8147 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
8148 else
8149 return 0;
8150 break;
8152 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
8153 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
8154 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
8155 op = DW_OP_and;
8156 goto do_binop;
8158 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
8159 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
8160 op = DW_OP_xor;
8161 goto do_binop;
8163 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
8164 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
8165 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
8166 op = DW_OP_or;
8167 goto do_binop;
8169 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
8170 op = DW_OP_div;
8171 goto do_binop;
8173 case MINUS_EXPR:
8174 op = DW_OP_minus;
8175 goto do_binop;
8177 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
8178 op = DW_OP_mod;
8179 goto do_binop;
8181 case MULT_EXPR:
8182 op = DW_OP_mul;
8183 goto do_binop;
8185 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
8186 op = DW_OP_shl;
8187 goto do_binop;
8189 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
8190 op = (unsignedp ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
8191 goto do_binop;
8193 case PLUS_EXPR:
8194 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
8195 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
8197 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8198 if (ret == 0)
8199 return 0;
8201 add_loc_descr (&ret,
8202 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
8203 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
8205 0));
8206 break;
8209 op = DW_OP_plus;
8210 goto do_binop;
8212 case LE_EXPR:
8213 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
8214 return 0;
8216 op = DW_OP_le;
8217 goto do_binop;
8219 case GE_EXPR:
8220 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
8221 return 0;
8223 op = DW_OP_ge;
8224 goto do_binop;
8226 case LT_EXPR:
8227 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
8228 return 0;
8230 op = DW_OP_lt;
8231 goto do_binop;
8233 case GT_EXPR:
8234 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
8235 return 0;
8237 op = DW_OP_gt;
8238 goto do_binop;
8240 case EQ_EXPR:
8241 op = DW_OP_eq;
8242 goto do_binop;
8244 case NE_EXPR:
8245 op = DW_OP_ne;
8246 goto do_binop;
8248 do_binop:
8249 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8250 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
8251 if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
8252 return 0;
8254 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
8255 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
8256 break;
8258 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
8259 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
8260 op = DW_OP_not;
8261 goto do_unop;
8263 case ABS_EXPR:
8264 op = DW_OP_abs;
8265 goto do_unop;
8267 case NEGATE_EXPR:
8268 op = DW_OP_neg;
8269 goto do_unop;
8271 do_unop:
8272 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8273 if (ret == 0)
8274 return 0;
8276 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
8277 break;
8279 case MAX_EXPR:
8280 loc = build (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
8281 build (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
8282 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
8283 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
8285 /* ... fall through ... */
8287 case COND_EXPR:
8289 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
8290 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
8291 dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
8292 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
8293 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
8295 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8296 if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
8297 return 0;
8299 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
8300 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
8302 add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
8303 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
8304 add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
8306 add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
8307 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
8308 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
8310 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
8311 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
8312 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
8313 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
8314 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
8316 break;
8318 default:
8319 abort ();
8322 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
8323 if (addressp && indirect_p == 0)
8324 return 0;
8326 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
8327 if (!addressp && indirect_p > 0)
8329 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
8331 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
8332 return 0;
8333 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
8334 op = DW_OP_deref;
8335 else
8336 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
8338 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
8341 return ret;
8344 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
8345 which is not less than the value itself. */
8347 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
8348 ceiling (value, boundary)
8349 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
8350 unsigned int boundary;
8352 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
8355 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
8356 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
8357 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
8358 ERROR_MARK node. */
8360 static inline tree
8361 field_type (decl)
8362 tree decl;
8364 tree type;
8366 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
8367 return integer_type_node;
8369 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
8370 if (type == NULL_TREE)
8371 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
8373 return type;
8376 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
8377 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
8378 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
8380 static inline unsigned
8381 simple_type_align_in_bits (type)
8382 tree type;
8384 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
8387 static inline unsigned
8388 simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl)
8389 tree decl;
8391 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
8394 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
8395 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
8396 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
8397 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
8398 ERROR_MARK node. */
8400 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
8401 simple_type_size_in_bits (type)
8402 tree type;
8405 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8406 return BITS_PER_WORD;
8407 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
8408 return 0;
8409 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
8410 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
8411 else
8412 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
8415 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
8416 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
8417 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
8418 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
8419 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
8420 just yet). */
8422 static HOST_WIDE_INT
8423 field_byte_offset (decl)
8424 tree decl;
8426 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
8427 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
8428 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
8429 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
8430 tree type;
8431 tree field_size_tree;
8432 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
8433 HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
8434 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
8436 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
8437 return 0;
8438 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FIELD_DECL)
8439 abort ();
8441 type = field_type (decl);
8442 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
8444 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
8445 a flexible array member. */
8446 if (! field_size_tree)
8447 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
8449 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
8450 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
8451 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
8452 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
8453 return 0;
8455 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
8457 /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word. */
8458 if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
8459 field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
8460 else
8461 field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
8463 type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
8464 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
8465 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
8467 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the starting
8468 bit offset (relative to the start of the containing structure type) of the
8469 hypothetical "containing object" for a bit-field. Thus, when computing
8470 the byte offset value for the start of the "containing object" of a
8471 bit-field, we must deduce this information on our own. This can be rather
8472 tricky to do in some cases. For example, handling the following structure
8473 type definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only aligns
8474 long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
8476 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
8478 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used in such
8479 cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will allocate 8 bytes for the
8480 structure shown above. It decides to do this based upon one simple rule
8481 for bit-field allocation. GCC allocates each "containing object" for each
8482 bit-field at the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment
8483 boundary (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared type
8484 of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the condition that
8485 there is still enough available space remaining in the containing object
8486 (when allocated at the selected point) to fully accommodate all of the
8487 bits of the bit-field itself.
8489 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for each
8490 object of the structure type shown above. When looking for a place to
8491 allocate the "containing object" for `field2', the compiler simply tries
8492 to allocate a 64-bit "containing object" at each successive 32-bit
8493 boundary (starting at zero) until it finds a place to allocate that 64-
8494 bit field such that at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated)
8495 bits remain within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
8496 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the "containing
8497 object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the structure type.)
8499 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts we're
8500 given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC must have believed
8501 that the containing object started (within the structure type). The value
8502 we deduce is then used (by the callers of this routine) to generate
8503 DW_AT_location and DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields
8504 and, in the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
8506 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to the
8507 "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
8508 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
8510 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce where the
8511 lowest addressed bit of the containing object must be. */
8512 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
8514 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for bitfields. */
8515 object_offset_in_bits += type_align_in_bits - 1;
8516 object_offset_in_bits /= type_align_in_bits;
8517 object_offset_in_bits *= type_align_in_bits;
8519 if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
8521 /* Sigh, the decl must be packed. */
8522 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
8524 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
8525 object_offset_in_bits += decl_align_in_bits - 1;
8526 object_offset_in_bits /= decl_align_in_bits;
8527 object_offset_in_bits *= decl_align_in_bits;
8530 return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
8533 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
8534 associated with them. */
8536 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
8538 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
8539 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
8540 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
8542 static void
8543 add_AT_location_description (die, attr_kind, rtl)
8544 dw_die_ref die;
8545 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
8546 rtx rtl;
8548 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = loc_descriptor (rtl);
8550 if (descr != 0)
8551 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
8554 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
8555 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
8556 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
8557 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
8558 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
8559 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
8560 function above).
8562 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
8563 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
8564 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
8565 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
8566 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
8567 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
8568 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
8569 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
8570 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
8571 function below.) */
8573 static void
8574 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, decl)
8575 dw_die_ref die;
8576 tree decl;
8578 long offset;
8579 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
8581 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_VEC)
8583 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
8584 if (TREE_VIA_VIRTUAL (decl) && is_cxx ())
8586 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
8587 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
8588 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
8589 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
8591 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
8593 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
8595 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
8597 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
8598 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
8599 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
8601 /* Extract the vtable address. */
8602 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
8603 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
8605 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
8606 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
8607 if (offset >= 0)
8608 abort ();
8610 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
8611 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
8612 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
8613 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
8615 /* Extract the offset. */
8616 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
8617 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
8619 /* Add it to the object address. */
8620 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
8621 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
8623 else
8624 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
8626 else
8627 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
8629 if (! loc_descr)
8631 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8633 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
8634 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
8635 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
8637 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
8638 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
8639 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
8640 stack. */
8641 op = DW_OP_constu;
8642 #else
8643 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
8644 #endif
8646 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
8649 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
8652 /* Attach an DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
8653 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
8654 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
8655 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
8656 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
8658 static void
8659 add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl)
8660 dw_die_ref die;
8661 rtx rtl;
8663 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8665 case CONST_INT:
8666 /* Note that a CONST_INT rtx could represent either an integer
8667 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_INT is used whenever
8668 the constant will fit into a single word. In all such
8669 cases, the original mode of the constant value is wiped
8670 out, and the CONST_INT rtx is assigned VOIDmode. */
8672 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
8674 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
8675 if (val < 0 && (long) val == val)
8676 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, (long) val);
8677 else if ((unsigned long) val == (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val)
8678 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned long) val);
8679 else
8681 #if HOST_BITS_PER_LONG * 2 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8682 add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
8683 val >> HOST_BITS_PER_LONG, val);
8684 #else
8685 abort ();
8686 #endif
8689 break;
8691 case CONST_DOUBLE:
8692 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
8693 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
8694 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
8695 represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
8697 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
8699 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
8701 unsigned length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 4;
8702 long *array = (long *) xmalloc (sizeof (long) * length);
8703 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
8705 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
8706 switch (mode)
8708 case SFmode:
8709 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (rv, array[0]);
8710 break;
8712 case DFmode:
8713 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (rv, array);
8714 break;
8716 case XFmode:
8717 case TFmode:
8718 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (rv, array);
8719 break;
8721 default:
8722 abort ();
8725 add_AT_float (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, array);
8727 else
8729 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
8730 if (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG != HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
8731 abort ();
8733 add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
8734 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
8737 break;
8739 case CONST_STRING:
8740 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
8741 break;
8743 case SYMBOL_REF:
8744 case LABEL_REF:
8745 case CONST:
8746 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
8747 VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, rtl);
8748 break;
8750 case PLUS:
8751 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
8752 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
8753 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
8754 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
8755 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
8756 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
8757 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
8758 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
8759 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
8760 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
8761 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
8762 break;
8764 default:
8765 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
8766 abort ();
8771 static rtx
8772 rtl_for_decl_location (decl)
8773 tree decl;
8775 rtx rtl;
8777 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
8778 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
8779 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
8781 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
8782 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
8783 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
8784 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
8785 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
8786 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
8787 referenced within the function.
8789 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
8790 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
8791 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
8792 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
8794 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
8795 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
8796 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
8797 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
8798 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
8799 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
8801 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
8802 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
8803 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
8804 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
8805 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
8806 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
8807 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
8808 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
8809 output at debug-time.
8811 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
8812 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
8813 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
8814 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
8815 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
8816 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
8817 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
8818 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
8819 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
8820 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
8821 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
8822 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
8823 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
8825 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
8826 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
8827 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
8828 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
8829 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
8830 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
8831 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
8832 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
8833 I'd like to fix it.
8835 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
8836 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
8837 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
8838 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
8839 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
8840 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
8841 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
8842 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
8843 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
8844 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
8845 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values, but integrate.c doesn't currently generate these
8846 values for inlined instances of inline function parameters, so when we see
8847 such cases, we are just out-of-luck for the time being (until integrate.c
8848 gets fixed). */
8850 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
8851 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
8853 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
8854 constants and symbols living in memory. */
8855 if (! reload_completed)
8857 if (rtl
8858 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
8859 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM
8860 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))))
8862 #ifdef ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR
8863 rtl = ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR (rtl);
8864 #endif
8865 return rtl;
8867 rtl = NULL_RTX;
8869 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
8871 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
8873 tree declared_type = type_main_variant (TREE_TYPE (decl));
8874 tree passed_type = type_main_variant (DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl));
8876 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
8877 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
8878 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
8879 if (declared_type == passed_type)
8880 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
8881 else if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
8882 && TREE_CODE (declared_type) == INTEGER_TYPE
8883 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (declared_type))
8884 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (passed_type))))
8885 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
8888 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
8889 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
8890 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
8891 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
8892 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
8893 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
8894 thing to do. */
8895 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM
8896 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
8897 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
8898 /* Not passed in memory. */
8899 && GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)) != MEM
8900 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
8901 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != REG
8902 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
8903 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
8904 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
8905 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
8906 #endif
8908 /* Big endian correction check. */
8909 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
8910 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
8911 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
8912 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
8914 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
8915 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
8917 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
8918 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
8922 if (rtl != NULL_RTX)
8924 rtl = eliminate_regs (rtl, 0, NULL_RTX);
8925 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8926 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8927 leaf_renumber_regs_insn (rtl);
8928 #endif
8931 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
8932 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
8933 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
8934 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
8936 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
8937 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
8938 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (decl)) == STRING_CST
8939 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
8941 tree arrtype = TREE_TYPE (decl);
8942 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (arrtype);
8943 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (arrtype);
8944 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
8945 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
8947 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
8948 && domain
8949 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
8950 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
8951 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
8952 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
8953 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
8954 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init));
8956 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
8957 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. Expanding anything else
8958 tends to produce unresolved symbols; see debug/5770 and c++/6381. */
8959 else if (TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (decl)) == INTEGER_CST
8960 || TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (decl)) == REAL_CST)
8962 rtl = expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (decl), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
8963 EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
8964 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
8965 if (rtl && GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM)
8966 abort ();
8970 #ifdef ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR
8971 if (rtl)
8972 rtl = ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR (rtl);
8973 #endif
8974 return rtl;
8977 /* Generate *either* an DW_AT_location attribute or else an DW_AT_const_value
8978 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
8979 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
8980 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
8981 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
8982 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
8983 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
8984 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
8985 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
8986 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
8988 static void
8989 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (die, decl)
8990 dw_die_ref die;
8991 tree decl;
8993 rtx rtl;
8995 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
8996 return;
8997 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL)
8998 abort ();
9000 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
9001 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9002 return;
9004 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
9005 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
9006 code, and thus is not emitted. */
9007 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
9009 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9011 case ADDRESSOF:
9012 /* The address of a variable that was optimized away; don't emit
9013 anything. */
9014 break;
9016 case CONST_INT:
9017 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9018 case CONST_STRING:
9019 case SYMBOL_REF:
9020 case LABEL_REF:
9021 case CONST:
9022 case PLUS:
9023 /* DECL_RTL could be (plus (reg ...) (const_int ...)) */
9024 add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
9025 break;
9027 case MEM:
9028 case REG:
9029 case SUBREG:
9030 case CONCAT:
9031 add_AT_location_description (die, DW_AT_location, rtl);
9032 break;
9034 default:
9035 abort ();
9039 /* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
9040 as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
9041 we should tell the debugger about the constant value. */
9043 static void
9044 tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl)
9045 dw_die_ref var_die;
9046 tree decl;
9048 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
9049 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9051 if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init
9052 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type) == null_pointer_node)
9053 /* OK */;
9054 else
9055 return;
9057 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
9059 case INTEGER_TYPE:
9060 if (host_integerp (init, 0))
9061 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_const_value,
9062 tree_low_cst (init, 0));
9063 else
9064 add_AT_long_long (var_die, DW_AT_const_value,
9065 TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (init),
9066 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (init));
9067 break;
9069 default:;
9073 /* Generate an DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
9074 the value of the attribute. */
9076 static inline void
9077 add_name_attribute (die, name_string)
9078 dw_die_ref die;
9079 const char *name_string;
9081 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
9083 if (demangle_name_func)
9084 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
9086 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
9090 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
9091 a representation for that bound. */
9093 static void
9094 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, bound)
9095 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
9096 enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr;
9097 tree bound;
9099 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
9101 case ERROR_MARK:
9102 return;
9104 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
9105 case INTEGER_CST:
9106 if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
9107 || (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
9108 && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound))
9109 || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
9110 /* use the default */
9112 else
9113 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
9114 break;
9116 case CONVERT_EXPR:
9117 case NOP_EXPR:
9118 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9119 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9120 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
9121 break;
9123 case SAVE_EXPR:
9124 /* If optimization is turned on, the SAVE_EXPRs that describe how to
9125 access the upper bound values may be bogus. If they refer to a
9126 register, they may only describe how to get at these values at the
9127 points in the generated code right after they have just been
9128 computed. Worse yet, in the typical case, the upper bound values
9129 will not even *be* computed in the optimized code (though the
9130 number of elements will), so these SAVE_EXPRs are entirely
9131 bogus. In order to compensate for this fact, we check here to see
9132 if optimization is enabled, and if so, we don't add an attribute
9133 for the (unknown and unknowable) upper bound. This should not
9134 cause too much trouble for existing (stupid?) debuggers because
9135 they have to deal with empty upper bounds location descriptions
9136 anyway in order to be able to deal with incomplete array types.
9137 Of course an intelligent debugger (GDB?) should be able to
9138 comprehend that a missing upper bound specification in an array
9139 type used for a storage class `auto' local array variable
9140 indicates that the upper bound is both unknown (at compile- time)
9141 and unknowable (at run-time) due to optimization.
9143 We assume that a MEM rtx is safe because gcc wouldn't put the
9144 value there unless it was going to be used repeatedly in the
9145 function, i.e. for cleanups. */
9146 if (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (bound)
9147 && (! optimize || GET_CODE (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (bound)) == MEM))
9149 dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
9150 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
9151 rtx loc = SAVE_EXPR_RTL (bound);
9153 /* If the RTL for the SAVE_EXPR is memory, handle the case where
9154 it references an outer function's frame. */
9155 if (GET_CODE (loc) == MEM)
9157 rtx new_addr = fix_lexical_addr (XEXP (loc, 0), bound);
9159 if (XEXP (loc, 0) != new_addr)
9160 loc = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (loc), new_addr);
9163 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
9164 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
9165 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
9166 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
9169 /* Else leave out the attribute. */
9170 break;
9172 case VAR_DECL:
9173 case PARM_DECL:
9175 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
9177 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
9178 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
9179 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
9180 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
9181 later parameter. */
9182 if (decl_die != NULL)
9183 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
9184 break;
9187 default:
9189 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
9190 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
9192 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
9193 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
9195 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound, 0);
9196 if (loc == NULL)
9197 break;
9199 if (current_function_decl == 0)
9200 ctx = comp_unit_die;
9201 else
9202 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
9204 /* If we weren't able to find a context, it's most likely the case
9205 that we are processing the return type of the function. So
9206 make a SAVE_EXPR to point to it and have the limbo DIE code
9207 find the proper die. The save_expr function doesn't always
9208 make a SAVE_EXPR, so do it ourselves. */
9209 if (ctx == 0)
9210 bound = build (SAVE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (bound), bound,
9211 current_function_decl, NULL_TREE);
9213 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
9214 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
9215 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
9216 add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
9218 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
9219 break;
9224 /* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
9225 includes information about the element type of type given array type. */
9227 static void
9228 add_subscript_info (type_die, type)
9229 dw_die_ref type_die;
9230 tree type;
9232 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9233 unsigned dimension_number;
9234 #endif
9235 tree lower, upper;
9236 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
9238 /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
9239 one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
9240 types. Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
9241 type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
9242 Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
9243 compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
9244 arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
9245 (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this. */
9247 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
9248 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
9249 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
9250 gen_array_type_die. */
9251 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9252 for (dimension_number = 0;
9253 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
9254 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
9255 #endif
9257 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
9259 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
9260 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
9261 here. */
9262 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
9263 if (domain)
9265 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
9266 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
9267 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
9269 /* define the index type. */
9270 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
9272 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
9273 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
9274 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
9275 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
9276 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
9277 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
9278 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
9280 else
9281 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
9282 type_die);
9285 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
9286 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
9287 dimension arr(N:*)
9288 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
9289 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
9290 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
9292 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
9293 if (upper)
9294 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
9297 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
9298 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
9299 bounds. */
9303 static void
9304 add_byte_size_attribute (die, tree_node)
9305 dw_die_ref die;
9306 tree tree_node;
9308 unsigned size;
9310 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
9312 case ERROR_MARK:
9313 size = 0;
9314 break;
9315 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
9316 case RECORD_TYPE:
9317 case UNION_TYPE:
9318 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
9319 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
9320 break;
9321 case FIELD_DECL:
9322 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
9323 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
9324 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
9325 even for bit-fields. */
9326 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9327 break;
9328 default:
9329 abort ();
9332 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
9333 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
9334 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
9335 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
9336 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
9339 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
9340 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
9341 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
9342 bit-field itself.
9344 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
9345 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
9346 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
9347 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
9348 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
9349 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
9351 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
9352 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
9353 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
9355 static inline void
9356 add_bit_offset_attribute (die, decl)
9357 dw_die_ref die;
9358 tree decl;
9360 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
9361 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
9362 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
9363 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
9364 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
9365 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
9367 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
9368 if (!type
9369 || TREE_CODE (decl) != FIELD_DECL)
9370 abort ();
9372 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
9373 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
9374 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
9375 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
9376 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
9377 return;
9379 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
9381 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
9382 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
9383 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
9384 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
9385 below must take account of these differences. */
9386 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
9387 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
9389 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
9391 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
9392 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
9395 bit_offset
9396 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
9397 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
9398 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
9400 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
9403 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
9404 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
9406 static inline void
9407 add_bit_size_attribute (die, decl)
9408 dw_die_ref die;
9409 tree decl;
9411 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
9412 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FIELD_DECL
9413 || ! DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
9414 abort ();
9416 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
9417 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
9420 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
9421 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
9423 static inline void
9424 add_prototyped_attribute (die, func_type)
9425 dw_die_ref die;
9426 tree func_type;
9428 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
9429 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
9430 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
9433 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
9434 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
9435 equate table. */
9437 static inline void
9438 add_abstract_origin_attribute (die, origin)
9439 dw_die_ref die;
9440 tree origin;
9442 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
9444 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
9446 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
9447 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
9448 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
9450 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
9451 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
9452 tree fn = origin;
9454 if (TYPE_P (fn))
9455 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
9457 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
9458 if (fn)
9459 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
9462 if (DECL_P (origin))
9463 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
9464 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
9465 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
9467 if (origin_die == NULL)
9468 abort ();
9470 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
9473 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
9475 static inline void
9476 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (die, func_decl)
9477 dw_die_ref die;
9478 tree func_decl;
9480 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
9482 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
9484 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
9485 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
9486 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
9487 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
9488 0));
9490 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
9491 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
9492 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
9493 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
9497 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
9499 static void
9500 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl)
9501 dw_die_ref die;
9502 tree decl;
9504 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (decl));
9506 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
9507 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl));
9510 /* Add an DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
9511 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
9513 static void
9514 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, decl)
9515 dw_die_ref die;
9516 tree decl;
9518 tree decl_name;
9520 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
9521 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
9523 add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
9524 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
9525 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
9527 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
9528 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
9529 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
9530 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
9531 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
9532 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
9535 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9536 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
9537 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
9538 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
9540 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
9541 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
9542 VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
9544 #endif
9547 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
9549 static void
9550 push_decl_scope (scope)
9551 tree scope;
9553 VARRAY_PUSH_TREE (decl_scope_table, scope);
9556 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
9558 static inline void
9559 pop_decl_scope ()
9561 if (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (decl_scope_table) <= 0)
9562 abort ();
9564 VARRAY_POP (decl_scope_table);
9567 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
9568 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
9569 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
9570 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
9571 the current active scope. */
9573 static dw_die_ref
9574 scope_die_for (t, context_die)
9575 tree t;
9576 dw_die_ref context_die;
9578 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
9579 tree containing_scope;
9580 int i;
9582 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
9583 if (! TYPE_P (t))
9584 abort ();
9586 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
9588 /* Ignore namespaces for the moment. */
9589 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
9590 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
9592 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
9593 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
9594 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
9595 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
9596 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
9598 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
9599 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
9600 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
9602 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
9603 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
9604 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
9605 for (i = VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
9606 if (VARRAY_TREE (decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
9607 break;
9609 if (i < 0)
9611 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
9612 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope))
9613 abort ();
9615 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
9616 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
9618 else
9619 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
9621 else
9622 scope_die = context_die;
9624 return scope_die;
9627 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
9629 static inline int
9630 local_scope_p (context_die)
9631 dw_die_ref context_die;
9633 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
9634 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
9635 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
9636 return 1;
9638 return 0;
9641 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
9643 static inline int
9644 class_scope_p (context_die)
9645 dw_die_ref context_die;
9647 return (context_die
9648 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
9649 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
9652 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
9653 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
9654 by 'type', and adds an DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
9656 static void
9657 add_type_attribute (object_die, type, decl_const, decl_volatile, context_die)
9658 dw_die_ref object_die;
9659 tree type;
9660 int decl_const;
9661 int decl_volatile;
9662 dw_die_ref context_die;
9664 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
9665 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
9667 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral or
9668 floating-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
9669 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
9670 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
9671 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE)
9672 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
9673 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
9675 if (code == ERROR_MARK
9676 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
9677 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
9678 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
9679 || code == VOID_TYPE)
9680 return;
9682 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
9683 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
9684 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
9685 context_die);
9687 if (type_die != NULL)
9688 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
9691 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
9692 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
9693 was declared without a tag. */
9695 static const char *
9696 type_tag (type)
9697 tree type;
9699 const char *name = 0;
9701 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
9703 tree t = 0;
9705 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
9706 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
9707 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
9709 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
9710 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
9711 involved. */
9712 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
9713 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
9714 t = DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type));
9716 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
9717 if (t != 0)
9718 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
9721 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
9724 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
9725 for bit field types. */
9727 static inline tree
9728 member_declared_type (member)
9729 tree member;
9731 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
9732 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
9735 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
9736 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
9738 #if 0
9739 static const char *
9740 decl_start_label (decl)
9741 tree decl;
9743 rtx x;
9744 const char *fnname;
9746 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
9747 if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM)
9748 abort ();
9750 x = XEXP (x, 0);
9751 if (GET_CODE (x) != SYMBOL_REF)
9752 abort ();
9754 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
9755 return fnname;
9757 #endif
9759 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
9760 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
9761 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
9763 static void
9764 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die)
9765 tree type;
9766 dw_die_ref context_die;
9768 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
9769 dw_die_ref array_die;
9770 tree element_type;
9772 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
9773 the inner array type comes before the outer array type. Thus we must
9774 call gen_type_die before we call new_die. See below also. */
9775 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9776 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
9777 #endif
9779 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
9780 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
9781 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
9783 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
9785 /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
9786 containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
9787 type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
9788 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
9791 #if 0
9792 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
9793 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
9794 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
9795 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
9796 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
9797 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
9798 for multidimensional arrays. */
9799 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
9800 #endif
9802 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9803 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
9804 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
9805 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
9806 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
9807 else
9808 #endif
9809 add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
9811 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type. */
9812 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
9814 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
9815 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
9816 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
9817 add_subscript_info. */
9818 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9819 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
9820 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
9822 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
9823 #endif
9825 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
9828 static void
9829 gen_set_type_die (type, context_die)
9830 tree type;
9831 dw_die_ref context_die;
9833 dw_die_ref type_die
9834 = new_die (DW_TAG_set_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
9836 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
9837 add_type_attribute (type_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
9840 #if 0
9841 static void
9842 gen_entry_point_die (decl, context_die)
9843 tree decl;
9844 dw_die_ref context_die;
9846 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
9847 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
9849 if (origin != NULL)
9850 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
9851 else
9853 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
9854 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
9855 0, 0, context_die);
9858 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
9859 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
9860 else
9861 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
9863 #endif
9865 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
9866 emit full debugging info for them. */
9868 static void
9869 retry_incomplete_types ()
9871 int i;
9873 for (i = VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9874 gen_type_die (VARRAY_TREE (incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
9877 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type. */
9879 static void
9880 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die)
9881 tree type;
9882 dw_die_ref context_die;
9884 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
9886 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
9887 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
9888 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
9891 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type. */
9893 static void
9894 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die)
9895 tree type;
9896 dw_die_ref context_die;
9898 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_structure_type, context_die, type);
9900 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
9901 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
9902 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
9905 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type. */
9907 static void
9908 gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die)
9909 tree type;
9910 dw_die_ref context_die;
9912 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
9914 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
9915 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
9916 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
9919 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
9920 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
9921 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
9922 DIE. */
9924 static void
9925 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die)
9926 tree type;
9927 dw_die_ref context_die;
9929 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
9931 if (type_die == NULL)
9933 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
9934 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
9935 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
9936 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
9938 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
9939 return;
9940 else
9941 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
9943 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
9944 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
9945 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
9946 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
9948 tree link;
9950 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
9951 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
9952 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
9953 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
9955 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
9956 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
9957 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
9958 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
9960 for (link = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
9961 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
9963 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
9965 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
9966 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
9968 if (host_integerp (TREE_VALUE (link), 0))
9970 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (TREE_VALUE (link)) < 0)
9971 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
9972 tree_low_cst (TREE_VALUE (link), 0));
9973 else
9974 add_AT_unsigned (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
9975 tree_low_cst (TREE_VALUE (link), 0));
9979 else
9980 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
9983 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
9984 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
9985 type.
9987 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
9988 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
9989 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
9990 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
9991 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
9992 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
9993 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
9994 argument type of some subprogram type. */
9996 static dw_die_ref
9997 gen_formal_parameter_die (node, context_die)
9998 tree node;
9999 dw_die_ref context_die;
10001 dw_die_ref parm_die
10002 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
10003 tree origin;
10005 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
10007 case 'd':
10008 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
10009 if (origin != NULL)
10010 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
10011 else
10013 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
10014 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (node),
10015 TREE_READONLY (node),
10016 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
10017 context_die);
10018 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
10019 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10022 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
10023 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
10024 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node);
10026 break;
10028 case 't':
10029 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
10030 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
10031 break;
10033 default:
10034 abort ();
10037 return parm_die;
10040 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
10041 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
10043 static void
10044 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl_or_type, context_die)
10045 tree decl_or_type;
10046 dw_die_ref context_die;
10048 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
10051 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
10052 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
10053 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
10054 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
10056 static void
10057 gen_formal_types_die (function_or_method_type, context_die)
10058 tree function_or_method_type;
10059 dw_die_ref context_die;
10061 tree link;
10062 tree formal_type = NULL;
10063 tree first_parm_type;
10064 tree arg;
10066 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
10068 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
10069 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
10071 else
10072 arg = NULL_TREE;
10074 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
10076 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
10077 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
10078 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
10080 dw_die_ref parm_die;
10082 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
10083 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
10084 break;
10086 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
10087 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
10088 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
10089 && link == first_parm_type)
10090 || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
10091 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10093 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
10094 if (arg)
10095 arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
10098 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
10099 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
10100 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
10101 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
10103 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
10104 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
10105 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
10106 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
10107 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
10108 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
10111 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
10112 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
10113 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
10114 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
10115 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
10117 static void
10118 gen_type_die_for_member (type, member, context_die)
10119 tree type, member;
10120 dw_die_ref context_die;
10122 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
10124 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
10125 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
10126 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
10127 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
10129 if (decl_ultimate_origin (member))
10130 abort ();
10132 push_decl_scope (type);
10133 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
10134 gen_subprogram_die (member, lookup_type_die (type));
10135 else
10136 gen_variable_die (member, lookup_type_die (type));
10138 pop_decl_scope ();
10142 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
10143 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
10145 static void
10146 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl)
10147 tree decl;
10149 dw_die_ref old_die;
10150 tree save_fn;
10151 tree context;
10152 int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
10154 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
10155 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
10157 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
10158 if (old_die && get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
10159 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
10160 return;
10162 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
10163 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
10164 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10166 context = decl_class_context (decl);
10167 if (context)
10168 gen_type_die_for_member
10169 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
10172 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
10173 save_fn = current_function_decl;
10174 current_function_decl = decl;
10176 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
10177 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
10178 if (! was_abstract)
10179 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
10181 current_function_decl = save_fn;
10184 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
10185 block-local). */
10187 static void
10188 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die)
10189 tree decl;
10190 dw_die_ref context_die;
10192 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10193 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
10194 dw_die_ref subr_die;
10195 rtx fp_reg;
10196 tree fn_arg_types;
10197 tree outer_scope;
10198 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
10199 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
10200 || class_scope_p (context_die));
10202 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
10203 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
10204 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
10205 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
10206 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
10208 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
10209 if (origin && declaration && class_scope_p (context_die))
10211 origin = NULL;
10212 if (old_die)
10213 abort ();
10216 if (origin != NULL)
10218 if (declaration && ! local_scope_p (context_die))
10219 abort ();
10221 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
10222 inline function. */
10223 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
10224 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
10226 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
10227 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
10229 else if (old_die)
10231 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (decl));
10233 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
10234 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
10235 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
10236 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
10237 && !get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
10239 /* ??? This can happen if there is a bug in the program, for
10240 instance, if it has duplicate function definitions. Ideally,
10241 we should detect this case and ignore it. For now, if we have
10242 already reported an error, any error at all, then assume that
10243 we got here because of an input error, not a dwarf2 bug. */
10244 if (errorcount)
10245 return;
10246 abort ();
10249 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
10250 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
10251 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
10252 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
10253 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
10254 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
10255 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
10256 if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
10257 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
10258 || (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
10259 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
10260 == (unsigned) DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl)))))
10262 subr_die = old_die;
10264 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the parm types. */
10265 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
10266 remove_children (subr_die);
10268 else
10270 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
10271 add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_specification, old_die);
10272 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
10273 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
10274 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
10275 != (unsigned) DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl))
10276 add_AT_unsigned
10277 (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl));
10280 else
10282 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
10284 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
10285 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
10287 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
10288 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10290 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
10291 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10292 0, 0, context_die);
10295 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
10296 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
10297 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10299 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
10300 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
10301 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
10302 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
10305 if (declaration)
10307 if (!old_die || !get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
10309 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
10311 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
10312 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
10313 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
10314 handled above. The two may come from the same source text. */
10315 if (DECL_CONTEXT (decl) || DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10316 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
10319 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10321 if (DECL_INLINE (decl) && !flag_no_inline)
10323 /* ??? Checking DECL_DEFER_OUTPUT is correct for static
10324 inline functions, but not for extern inline functions.
10325 We can't get this completely correct because information
10326 about whether the function was declared inline is not
10327 saved anywhere. */
10328 if (DECL_DEFER_OUTPUT (decl))
10329 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
10330 else
10331 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
10333 else
10334 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
10336 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
10338 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
10340 if (!old_die || !get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
10341 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
10343 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
10344 current_funcdef_number);
10345 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
10346 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
10347 current_funcdef_number);
10348 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
10350 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
10351 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
10353 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10354 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
10355 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
10356 #endif
10358 /* Define the "frame base" location for this routine. We use the
10359 frame pointer or stack pointer registers, since the RTL for local
10360 variables is relative to one of them. */
10361 fp_reg
10362 = frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx : stack_pointer_rtx;
10363 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, reg_loc_descriptor (fp_reg));
10365 #if 0
10366 /* ??? This fails for nested inline functions, because context_display
10367 is not part of the state saved/restored for inline functions. */
10368 if (current_function_needs_context)
10369 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
10370 lookup_static_chain (decl));
10371 #endif
10374 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
10375 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
10376 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
10377 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
10378 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
10379 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
10380 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
10381 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
10382 an ellipsis at the end. */
10384 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
10385 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
10386 its formal parameters. */
10387 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10389 else if (declaration)
10390 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
10391 else
10393 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters */
10394 tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
10395 tree parm;
10397 /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
10398 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
10399 for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
10400 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
10402 if (DECL_NAME (parm)
10403 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
10404 "__builtin_va_alist"))
10405 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
10406 else
10407 gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
10410 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
10411 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
10412 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
10413 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
10414 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
10415 parameters at all. */
10416 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
10417 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
10419 /* this is the prototyped case, check for ... */
10420 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
10421 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
10423 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
10424 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
10427 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
10428 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
10429 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
10431 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
10432 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
10433 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
10434 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
10435 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
10436 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
10437 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
10439 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
10440 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
10441 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
10442 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
10443 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
10444 constructor function. */
10445 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
10447 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
10448 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
10450 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10451 if (current_function_has_inlines)
10453 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
10454 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
10456 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
10457 comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
10460 #endif
10464 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object. */
10466 static void
10467 gen_variable_die (decl, context_die)
10468 tree decl;
10469 dw_die_ref context_die;
10471 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
10472 dw_die_ref var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
10474 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
10475 int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
10476 || class_scope_p (context_die));
10478 if (origin != NULL)
10479 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
10481 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
10482 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
10484 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
10485 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
10486 sharing them.
10488 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges. */
10489 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl)
10490 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
10492 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
10493 add_AT_die_ref (var_die, DW_AT_specification, old_die);
10494 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
10496 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (decl));
10498 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
10499 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
10501 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
10502 != (unsigned) DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl))
10504 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line,
10505 DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl));
10508 else
10510 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
10511 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
10512 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
10514 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
10515 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
10517 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
10518 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10520 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
10521 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
10522 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
10523 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
10526 if (declaration)
10527 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
10529 if (class_scope_p (context_die) || DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10530 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
10532 if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10534 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
10535 add_pubname (decl, var_die);
10537 else
10538 tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
10541 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
10543 static void
10544 gen_label_die (decl, context_die)
10545 tree decl;
10546 dw_die_ref context_die;
10548 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
10549 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
10550 rtx insn;
10551 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10553 if (origin != NULL)
10554 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
10555 else
10556 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
10558 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10559 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
10560 else
10562 insn = DECL_RTL (decl);
10564 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
10565 eliminated because of various optimisations. We still emit them
10566 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
10567 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL
10568 || ((GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE
10569 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL)))
10571 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
10572 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
10573 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
10574 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
10575 it if it ever does happen. */
10576 if (INSN_DELETED_P (insn))
10577 abort ();
10579 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
10580 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
10585 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
10587 static void
10588 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth)
10589 tree stmt;
10590 dw_die_ref context_die;
10591 int depth;
10593 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
10594 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10596 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
10598 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
10600 tree chain;
10602 add_AT_range_list (stmt_die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
10604 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
10607 add_ranges (chain);
10608 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
10610 while (chain);
10611 add_ranges (NULL);
10613 else
10615 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
10616 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
10617 add_AT_lbl_id (stmt_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
10618 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
10619 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
10620 add_AT_lbl_id (stmt_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
10624 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
10627 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
10629 static void
10630 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth)
10631 tree stmt;
10632 dw_die_ref context_die;
10633 int depth;
10635 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
10637 dw_die_ref subr_die
10638 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
10639 tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
10640 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10642 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. */
10643 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
10645 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
10646 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
10647 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
10648 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
10649 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
10650 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
10651 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
10652 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
10653 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
10655 else
10656 /* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
10657 inlined into function B that was inlined into function C. When
10658 generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
10659 would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
10660 So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
10661 for this one. Instead, just emit debugging info for
10662 declarations within the block. This is particularly important
10663 in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
10664 if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
10665 wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
10666 when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
10667 intended :-) */
10668 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
10671 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
10673 static void
10674 gen_field_die (decl, context_die)
10675 tree decl;
10676 dw_die_ref context_die;
10678 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
10680 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
10681 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
10682 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
10683 context_die);
10685 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
10687 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
10688 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
10689 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
10692 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
10693 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
10695 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
10696 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10698 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
10699 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
10700 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
10701 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
10704 #if 0
10705 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
10706 Use modified_type_die instead.
10707 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
10708 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
10710 static void
10711 gen_pointer_type_die (type, context_die)
10712 tree type;
10713 dw_die_ref context_die;
10715 dw_die_ref ptr_die
10716 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
10718 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
10719 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
10720 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
10723 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
10724 Use modified_type_die instead.
10725 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
10726 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
10728 static void
10729 gen_reference_type_die (type, context_die)
10730 tree type;
10731 dw_die_ref context_die;
10733 dw_die_ref ref_die
10734 = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
10736 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
10737 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
10738 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
10740 #endif
10742 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
10744 static void
10745 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die)
10746 tree type;
10747 dw_die_ref context_die;
10749 dw_die_ref ptr_die
10750 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
10751 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
10753 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
10754 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
10755 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
10756 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
10759 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
10761 static dw_die_ref
10762 gen_compile_unit_die (filename)
10763 const char *filename;
10765 dw_die_ref die;
10766 char producer[250];
10767 const char *wd = getpwd ();
10768 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
10769 int language;
10771 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
10772 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
10774 if (wd != NULL && filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
10775 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
10777 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
10779 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10780 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
10781 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
10782 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
10783 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
10784 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
10785 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
10786 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10787 strcat (producer, " -g");
10788 #endif
10790 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
10792 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
10793 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
10794 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
10795 language = DW_LANG_Ada83;
10796 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
10797 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
10798 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
10799 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
10800 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
10801 language = DW_LANG_Java;
10802 else
10803 language = DW_LANG_C89;
10805 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
10806 return die;
10809 /* Generate a DIE for a string type. */
10811 static void
10812 gen_string_type_die (type, context_die)
10813 tree type;
10814 dw_die_ref context_die;
10816 dw_die_ref type_die
10817 = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
10819 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
10821 /* ??? Fudge the string length attribute for now.
10822 TODO: add string length info. */
10823 #if 0
10824 string_length_attribute (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)));
10825 bound_representation (upper_bound, 0, 'u');
10826 #endif
10829 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
10831 static void
10832 gen_inheritance_die (binfo, context_die)
10833 tree binfo;
10834 dw_die_ref context_die;
10836 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
10838 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
10839 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
10841 if (TREE_VIA_VIRTUAL (binfo))
10842 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
10844 if (TREE_VIA_PUBLIC (binfo))
10845 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
10846 else if (TREE_VIA_PROTECTED (binfo))
10847 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
10850 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
10852 static void
10853 gen_member_die (type, context_die)
10854 tree type;
10855 dw_die_ref context_die;
10857 tree member;
10858 dw_die_ref child;
10860 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
10861 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
10862 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
10863 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
10864 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
10865 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
10866 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
10867 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
10868 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
10869 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
10870 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
10872 /* First output info about the base classes. */
10873 if (TYPE_BINFO (type) && TYPE_BINFO_BASETYPES (type))
10875 tree bases = TYPE_BINFO_BASETYPES (type);
10876 int n_bases = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (bases);
10877 int i;
10879 for (i = 0; i < n_bases; i++)
10880 gen_inheritance_die (TREE_VEC_ELT (bases, i), context_die);
10883 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
10884 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
10886 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
10887 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
10888 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
10889 do put them in the right order. */
10891 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
10892 if (child)
10893 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
10894 else
10895 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
10898 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
10899 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
10901 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
10902 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
10903 continue;
10905 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
10906 if (child)
10907 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
10908 else
10909 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
10913 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
10914 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
10915 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
10917 static void
10918 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die)
10919 tree type;
10920 dw_die_ref context_die;
10922 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
10923 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
10924 int nested = 0;
10925 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
10926 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
10927 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
10929 if (type_die && ! complete)
10930 return;
10932 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
10933 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
10934 nested = 1;
10936 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
10938 if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
10939 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
10941 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
10943 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
10944 ? DW_TAG_structure_type : DW_TAG_union_type,
10945 scope_die, type);
10946 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
10947 if (old_die)
10948 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_specification, old_die);
10949 else
10950 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
10952 else
10953 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
10955 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
10956 then give a list of members. */
10957 if (complete)
10959 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
10960 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
10961 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
10962 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
10963 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
10964 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
10966 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
10967 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
10968 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
10969 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
10971 push_decl_scope (type);
10972 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
10973 pop_decl_scope ();
10975 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
10976 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
10978 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
10980 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
10981 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
10982 lookup_type_die (vtype));
10985 else
10987 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
10989 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
10990 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
10991 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
10992 VARRAY_PUSH_TREE (incomplete_types, type);
10996 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
10998 static void
10999 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die)
11000 tree type;
11001 dw_die_ref context_die;
11003 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11004 dw_die_ref subr_die
11005 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
11006 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11008 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
11009 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
11010 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
11011 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
11014 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition */
11016 static void
11017 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die)
11018 tree decl;
11019 dw_die_ref context_die;
11021 dw_die_ref type_die;
11022 tree origin;
11024 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
11025 return;
11027 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
11028 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
11029 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11030 if (origin != NULL)
11031 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
11032 else
11034 tree type;
11036 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
11037 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
11039 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
11041 if (type == TREE_TYPE (decl))
11042 abort ();
11043 else
11044 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
11046 else
11047 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
11049 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
11050 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
11053 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11054 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
11057 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
11059 static void
11060 gen_type_die (type, context_die)
11061 tree type;
11062 dw_die_ref context_die;
11064 int need_pop;
11066 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
11067 return;
11069 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
11070 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
11071 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
11072 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
11073 cloned type itself). */
11074 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
11075 type = type_main_variant (type);
11077 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
11078 return;
11080 if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
11081 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
11083 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
11084 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == type)
11085 abort ();
11087 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11088 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
11089 return;
11092 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
11094 case ERROR_MARK:
11095 break;
11097 case POINTER_TYPE:
11098 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
11099 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
11100 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
11101 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
11102 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
11103 statement. */
11104 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11106 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
11107 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
11108 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11109 break;
11111 case OFFSET_TYPE:
11112 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
11113 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
11114 gen_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die);
11116 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
11117 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11119 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
11120 itself. */
11121 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
11122 break;
11124 case SET_TYPE:
11125 gen_type_die (TYPE_DOMAIN (type), context_die);
11126 gen_set_type_die (type, context_die);
11127 break;
11129 case FILE_TYPE:
11130 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11131 abort (); /* No way to represent these in Dwarf yet! */
11132 break;
11134 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
11135 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
11136 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11137 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
11138 break;
11140 case METHOD_TYPE:
11141 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
11142 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11143 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
11144 break;
11146 case ARRAY_TYPE:
11147 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == CHAR_TYPE)
11149 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11150 gen_string_type_die (type, context_die);
11152 else
11153 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
11154 break;
11156 case VECTOR_TYPE:
11157 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
11158 break;
11160 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
11161 case RECORD_TYPE:
11162 case UNION_TYPE:
11163 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
11164 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
11165 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
11166 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
11167 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
11168 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
11169 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
11170 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
11171 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
11172 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
11174 gen_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die);
11176 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
11177 return;
11179 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
11180 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
11181 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
11182 need_pop = 1;
11184 else
11185 need_pop = 0;
11187 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
11188 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
11189 else
11190 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die);
11192 if (need_pop)
11193 pop_decl_scope ();
11195 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
11196 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
11197 when appropriate. */
11198 return;
11200 case VOID_TYPE:
11201 case INTEGER_TYPE:
11202 case REAL_TYPE:
11203 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
11204 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
11205 case CHAR_TYPE:
11206 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
11207 break;
11209 case LANG_TYPE:
11210 /* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
11211 break;
11213 default:
11214 abort ();
11217 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11220 /* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation. */
11222 static void
11223 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (type, context_die)
11224 tree type;
11225 dw_die_ref context_die;
11227 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
11228 return;
11230 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
11231 this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
11232 that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
11233 type now. */
11234 if (type != type_main_variant (type))
11235 abort ();
11237 /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
11238 an instance of an unresolved type. */
11240 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
11242 case ERROR_MARK:
11243 break;
11245 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
11246 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
11247 break;
11249 case RECORD_TYPE:
11250 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
11251 break;
11253 case UNION_TYPE:
11254 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
11255 gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
11256 break;
11258 default:
11259 abort ();
11263 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
11264 things which are local to the given block. */
11266 static void
11267 gen_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth)
11268 tree stmt;
11269 dw_die_ref context_die;
11270 int depth;
11272 int must_output_die = 0;
11273 tree origin;
11274 tree decl;
11275 enum tree_code origin_code;
11277 /* Ignore blocks never really used to make RTL. */
11278 if (stmt == NULL_TREE || !TREE_USED (stmt)
11279 || (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt) && !BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)))
11280 return;
11282 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
11283 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
11284 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
11285 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
11287 tree sub;
11289 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
11290 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
11292 return;
11295 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block. This block may be an
11296 inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
11297 to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
11298 sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
11299 the current block. */
11300 origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
11301 origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
11303 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
11304 block. */
11305 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
11306 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
11307 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
11308 must_output_die = 1;
11309 else
11311 /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
11312 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
11313 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
11314 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
11315 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules. So we
11316 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
11317 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag. */
11318 if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
11320 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
11321 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
11322 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11323 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
11324 as being a "significant" one. */
11325 must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL);
11326 else
11327 /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
11328 definitions count as "significant" local declarations. */
11329 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
11330 decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
11331 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
11332 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
11334 must_output_die = 1;
11335 break;
11340 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
11341 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
11342 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
11343 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
11344 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
11345 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
11346 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
11347 if (must_output_die)
11349 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
11350 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
11351 else
11352 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
11354 else
11355 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
11358 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
11359 all of its sub-blocks. */
11361 static void
11362 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth)
11363 tree stmt;
11364 dw_die_ref context_die;
11365 int depth;
11367 tree decl;
11368 tree subblocks;
11370 /* Ignore blocks never really used to make RTL. */
11371 if (stmt == NULL_TREE || ! TREE_USED (stmt))
11372 return;
11374 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
11375 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
11376 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
11377 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
11378 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
11380 dw_die_ref die;
11382 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11383 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11384 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
11385 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
11386 else
11387 die = NULL;
11389 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
11390 add_child_die (context_die, die);
11391 else
11392 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
11395 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
11396 therein) of this block. */
11397 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
11398 subblocks != NULL;
11399 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
11400 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
11403 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
11405 static inline int
11406 is_redundant_typedef (decl)
11407 tree decl;
11409 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
11410 return 1;
11412 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
11413 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
11414 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
11415 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
11416 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
11417 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
11418 return 1;
11420 return 0;
11423 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
11425 static void
11426 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die)
11427 tree decl;
11428 dw_die_ref context_die;
11430 tree origin;
11432 if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
11433 return;
11435 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
11437 case ERROR_MARK:
11438 break;
11440 case CONST_DECL:
11441 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
11442 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
11443 break;
11445 case FUNCTION_DECL:
11446 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
11447 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
11448 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
11449 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
11450 break;
11452 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
11453 if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
11454 dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
11456 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
11457 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
11458 else if (DECL_INLINE (decl) && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
11459 && ! class_scope_p (context_die)
11460 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
11461 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
11462 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
11463 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
11465 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
11466 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
11469 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
11470 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11472 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
11473 have described its return type. */
11474 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
11476 /* And its virtual context. */
11477 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
11478 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
11480 /* And its containing type. */
11481 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
11482 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
11483 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
11486 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
11487 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
11488 break;
11490 case TYPE_DECL:
11491 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
11492 actual typedefs. */
11493 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11494 break;
11496 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
11497 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
11498 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
11499 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
11500 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
11501 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. */
11502 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
11504 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
11505 break;
11508 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
11509 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
11510 else
11511 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
11512 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
11513 break;
11515 case LABEL_DECL:
11516 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
11517 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
11518 break;
11520 case VAR_DECL:
11521 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
11522 variable declarations or definitions. */
11523 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11524 break;
11526 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
11527 object. */
11528 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
11530 /* And its containing type. */
11531 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
11532 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
11533 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
11535 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
11536 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
11537 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
11538 function. */
11539 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11540 if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
11541 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
11542 else
11543 gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
11544 break;
11546 case FIELD_DECL:
11547 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
11548 anonymous unions. */
11549 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
11550 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE)
11552 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
11553 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
11555 break;
11557 case PARM_DECL:
11558 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
11559 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
11560 break;
11562 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
11563 /* Ignore for now. */
11564 break;
11566 default:
11567 abort ();
11571 static void
11572 mark_limbo_die_list (ptr)
11573 void *ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11575 limbo_die_node *node;
11576 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
11577 ggc_mark_tree (node->created_for);
11580 /* Add Ada "use" clause information for SGI Workshop debugger. */
11582 void
11583 dwarf2out_add_library_unit_info (filename, context_list)
11584 const char *filename;
11585 const char *context_list;
11587 unsigned int file_index;
11589 if (filename != NULL)
11591 dw_die_ref unit_die = new_die (DW_TAG_module, comp_unit_die, NULL);
11592 tree context_list_decl
11593 = build_decl (LABEL_DECL, get_identifier (context_list),
11594 void_type_node);
11596 TREE_PUBLIC (context_list_decl) = TRUE;
11597 add_name_attribute (unit_die, context_list);
11598 file_index = lookup_filename (filename);
11599 add_AT_unsigned (unit_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11600 add_pubname (context_list_decl, unit_die);
11604 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
11605 compilation proper has finished. */
11607 static void
11608 dwarf2out_global_decl (decl)
11609 tree decl;
11611 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
11612 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
11613 corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
11614 definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
11615 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
11616 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
11619 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
11621 void
11622 dwarf2out_decl (decl)
11623 tree decl;
11625 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
11627 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
11629 case ERROR_MARK:
11630 return;
11632 case FUNCTION_DECL:
11633 /* Ignore this FUNCTION_DECL if it refers to a builtin declaration of a
11634 builtin function. Explicit programmer-supplied declarations of
11635 these same functions should NOT be ignored however. */
11636 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && DECL_BUILT_IN (decl))
11637 return;
11639 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
11640 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
11641 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
11642 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
11643 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
11644 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
11645 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
11646 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
11647 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
11648 with the definition of the function.
11650 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
11651 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
11652 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
11653 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
11654 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
11655 translation unit (an thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
11656 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
11657 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
11658 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
11659 that they *are* definitions).
11661 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
11662 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
11663 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
11664 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
11665 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
11666 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
11667 return;
11669 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
11670 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
11671 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
11672 if (decl_function_context (decl))
11673 context_die = NULL;
11674 break;
11676 case VAR_DECL:
11677 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
11678 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
11679 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
11680 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
11681 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
11682 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
11683 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
11684 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
11685 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
11686 return;
11688 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
11689 variable declarations or definitions. */
11690 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11691 return;
11692 break;
11694 case TYPE_DECL:
11695 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
11696 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
11697 return;
11699 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
11700 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
11701 if (DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl) == 0)
11703 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
11704 comparisons have. */
11705 if ((get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
11706 == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus)
11707 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
11708 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
11709 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
11711 return;
11714 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
11715 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11716 return;
11718 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
11719 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
11720 if (decl_function_context (decl))
11721 context_die = NULL;
11723 break;
11725 default:
11726 return;
11729 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
11732 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
11733 a lexical block. */
11735 static void
11736 dwarf2out_begin_block (line, blocknum)
11737 unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11738 unsigned int blocknum;
11740 function_section (current_function_decl);
11741 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
11744 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
11745 lexical block. */
11747 static void
11748 dwarf2out_end_block (line, blocknum)
11749 unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11750 unsigned int blocknum;
11752 function_section (current_function_decl);
11753 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
11756 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
11757 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
11759 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
11760 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
11761 we may end up calling them anyway. */
11763 static bool
11764 dwarf2out_ignore_block (block)
11765 tree block;
11767 tree decl;
11769 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
11770 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
11771 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
11772 return 0;
11774 return 1;
11777 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
11778 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
11779 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
11780 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
11781 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
11782 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
11783 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
11784 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
11785 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
11786 all searches. */
11788 static unsigned
11789 lookup_filename (file_name)
11790 const char *file_name;
11792 unsigned i;
11794 /* ??? Why isn't DECL_SOURCE_FILE left null instead. */
11795 if (strcmp (file_name, "<internal>") == 0
11796 || strcmp (file_name, "<built-in>") == 0)
11797 return 0;
11799 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
11800 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
11801 if (file_table.last_lookup_index != 0)
11802 if (0 == strcmp (file_name,
11803 file_table.table[file_table.last_lookup_index]))
11804 return file_table.last_lookup_index;
11806 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table */
11807 for (i = 1; i < file_table.in_use; i++)
11808 if (strcmp (file_name, file_table.table[i]) == 0)
11810 file_table.last_lookup_index = i;
11811 return i;
11814 /* Prepare to add a new table entry by making sure there is enough space in
11815 the table to do so. If not, expand the current table. */
11816 if (i == file_table.allocated)
11818 file_table.allocated = i + FILE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11819 file_table.table = (char **)
11820 xrealloc (file_table.table, file_table.allocated * sizeof (char *));
11823 /* Add the new entry to the end of the filename table. */
11824 file_table.table[i] = xstrdup (file_name);
11825 file_table.in_use = i + 1;
11826 file_table.last_lookup_index = i;
11828 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
11829 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u \"%s\"\n", i, file_name);
11831 return i;
11834 static void
11835 init_file_table ()
11837 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the file_table. */
11838 file_table.table = (char **) xcalloc (FILE_TABLE_INCREMENT, sizeof (char *));
11839 file_table.allocated = FILE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11841 /* Skip the first entry - file numbers begin at 1. */
11842 file_table.in_use = 1;
11843 file_table.last_lookup_index = 0;
11846 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
11847 and record information relating to this source line, in
11848 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
11850 static void
11851 dwarf2out_source_line (line, filename)
11852 unsigned int line;
11853 const char *filename;
11855 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
11857 function_section (current_function_decl);
11859 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
11860 if (flag_debug_asm)
11861 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
11862 filename, line);
11864 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
11866 unsigned file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
11868 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
11869 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
11871 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
11872 line_info_table_in_use++;
11874 /* Indicate that multiple line number tables exist. */
11875 if (DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
11876 separate_line_info_table_in_use++;
11878 else if (DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
11880 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
11881 ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (asm_out_file, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
11882 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
11884 /* expand the line info table if necessary */
11885 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
11886 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
11888 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11889 separate_line_info_table
11890 = (dw_separate_line_info_ref)
11891 xrealloc (separate_line_info_table,
11892 separate_line_info_table_allocated
11893 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
11896 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
11897 line_info
11898 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
11899 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
11900 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
11901 line_info->function = current_funcdef_number;
11903 else
11905 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
11907 ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
11908 line_info_table_in_use);
11910 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
11911 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
11913 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11914 line_info_table
11915 = (dw_line_info_ref)
11916 xrealloc (line_info_table,
11917 (line_info_table_allocated
11918 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
11921 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
11922 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
11923 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
11924 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
11929 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
11931 static void
11932 dwarf2out_start_source_file (lineno, filename)
11933 unsigned int lineno;
11934 const char *filename;
11936 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
11938 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
11939 dw_die_ref bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
11940 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, filename);
11943 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
11945 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
11946 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
11947 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
11948 lineno);
11949 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lookup_filename (filename),
11950 "Filename we just started");
11954 /* Record the end of a source file. */
11956 static void
11957 dwarf2out_end_source_file (lineno)
11958 unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11960 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
11961 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
11962 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
11964 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
11966 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
11967 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
11971 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
11972 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
11973 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
11975 static void
11976 dwarf2out_define (lineno, buffer)
11977 unsigned lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11978 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11980 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
11982 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
11983 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
11984 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
11985 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
11989 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
11990 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
11991 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
11993 static void
11994 dwarf2out_undef (lineno, buffer)
11995 unsigned lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11996 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11998 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12000 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12001 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
12002 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
12003 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
12007 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
12009 static void
12010 dwarf2out_init (main_input_filename)
12011 const char *main_input_filename;
12013 init_file_table ();
12015 /* Remember the name of the primary input file. */
12016 primary_filename = main_input_filename;
12018 /* Add it to the file table first, under the assumption that we'll
12019 be emitting line number data for it first, which avoids having
12020 to add an initial DW_LNS_set_file. */
12021 lookup_filename (main_input_filename);
12023 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_die_table. */
12024 decl_die_table
12025 = (dw_die_ref *) xcalloc (DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT, sizeof (dw_die_ref));
12026 decl_die_table_allocated = DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
12027 decl_die_table_in_use = 0;
12029 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
12030 VARRAY_TREE_INIT (decl_scope_table, 256, "decl_scope_table");
12031 ggc_add_tree_varray_root (&decl_scope_table, 1);
12033 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
12034 abbrev_die_table
12035 = (dw_die_ref *) xcalloc (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT,
12036 sizeof (dw_die_ref));
12037 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
12038 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused */
12039 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
12041 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
12042 line_info_table
12043 = (dw_line_info_ref) xcalloc (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT,
12044 sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
12045 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
12047 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused */
12048 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
12050 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
12051 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
12052 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
12053 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
12054 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. */
12055 comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (main_input_filename);
12057 VARRAY_TREE_INIT (incomplete_types, 64, "incomplete_types");
12058 ggc_add_tree_varray_root (&incomplete_types, 1);
12060 VARRAY_RTX_INIT (used_rtx_varray, 32, "used_rtx_varray");
12061 ggc_add_rtx_varray_root (&used_rtx_varray, 1);
12063 ggc_add_root (&limbo_die_list, 1, 1, mark_limbo_die_list);
12065 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
12066 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
12067 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12068 if (DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL)
12069 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12070 else
12071 strcpy (text_section_label, stripattributes (TEXT_SECTION_NAME));
12073 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
12074 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12075 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
12076 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12077 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
12078 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12079 named_section_flags (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12080 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
12081 named_section_flags (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12082 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
12083 named_section_flags (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12084 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
12086 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12088 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12089 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
12090 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12091 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
12094 if (DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL)
12096 text_section ();
12097 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
12101 /* Allocate a string in .debug_str hash table. */
12103 static hashnode
12104 indirect_string_alloc (tab)
12105 hash_table *tab ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
12107 struct indirect_string_node *node;
12109 node = xmalloc (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
12110 node->refcount = 0;
12111 node->form = 0;
12112 node->label = NULL;
12114 return (hashnode) node;
12117 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
12118 ht_forall. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
12120 static int
12121 output_indirect_string (pfile, h, v)
12122 struct cpp_reader *pfile ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
12123 hashnode h;
12124 const PTR v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
12126 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) h;
12128 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
12130 named_section_flags (DEBUG_STR_SECTION, DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS);
12131 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
12132 assemble_string ((const char *) HT_STR (&node->id),
12133 HT_LEN (&node->id) + 1);
12136 return 1;
12139 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
12140 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
12142 static void
12143 dwarf2out_finish (input_filename)
12144 const char *input_filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
12146 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
12147 dw_die_ref die = 0;
12149 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
12150 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
12151 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
12152 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
12153 instance. */
12154 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
12156 next_node = node->next;
12157 die = node->die;
12159 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
12161 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
12162 tree context;
12164 if (origin)
12165 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
12166 else if (die == comp_unit_die)
12168 /* If this was an expression for a bound involved in a function
12169 return type, it may be a SAVE_EXPR for which we weren't able
12170 to find a DIE previously. So try now. */
12171 else if (node->created_for
12172 && TREE_CODE (node->created_for) == SAVE_EXPR
12173 && 0 != (origin = (lookup_decl_die
12174 (SAVE_EXPR_CONTEXT
12175 (node->created_for)))))
12176 add_child_die (origin, die);
12177 else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
12178 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
12179 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
12180 else if (node->created_for
12181 && ((DECL_P (node->created_for)
12182 && (context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for)))
12183 || (TYPE_P (node->created_for)
12184 && (context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for))))
12185 && TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12187 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
12188 nested function can be optimized away, which results
12189 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
12190 with the return type of that nested function. Force
12191 this to be a child of the containing function. */
12192 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
12193 if (! origin)
12194 abort ();
12195 add_child_die (origin, die);
12197 else
12198 abort ();
12201 free (node);
12204 limbo_die_list = NULL;
12206 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
12207 emit full debugging info for them. */
12208 retry_incomplete_types ();
12210 /* We need to reverse all the dies before break_out_includes, or
12211 we'll see the end of an include file before the beginning. */
12212 reverse_all_dies (comp_unit_die);
12214 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
12215 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
12216 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
12217 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
12219 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
12220 that have children. */
12221 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
12222 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
12223 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
12225 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
12226 text_section ();
12227 ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
12229 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
12230 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
12231 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
12232 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
12233 examining the file. */
12234 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
12236 named_section_flags (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12237 output_line_info ();
12240 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
12241 if (have_location_lists)
12243 /* Output the location lists info. */
12244 named_section_flags (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12245 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
12246 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12247 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
12248 output_location_lists (die);
12249 have_location_lists = 0;
12252 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
12253 in .text. */
12254 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use == 0)
12256 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
12257 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
12260 /* If it wasn't, we need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
12261 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become absolute. */
12262 else if (have_location_lists || ranges_table_in_use)
12263 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
12265 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
12266 add_AT_lbl_offset (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
12267 debug_line_section_label);
12269 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12270 add_AT_lbl_offset (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
12272 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
12273 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
12274 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
12275 output_comp_unit (node->die);
12277 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die);
12279 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
12280 named_section_flags (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12281 output_abbrev_section ();
12283 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
12284 if (pubname_table_in_use)
12286 named_section_flags (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12287 output_pubnames ();
12290 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
12291 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
12292 if (fde_table_in_use)
12294 named_section_flags (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12295 output_aranges ();
12298 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
12299 if (ranges_table_in_use)
12301 named_section_flags (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12302 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
12303 output_ranges ();
12306 /* Have to end the primary source file. */
12307 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12309 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12310 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
12313 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
12314 table too. */
12315 if (debug_str_hash)
12316 ht_forall (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
12318 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO || DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO */